1 ============================== 2 LLVM Language Reference Manual 3 ============================== 4 5 .. contents:: 6 :local: 7 :depth: 4 8 9 Abstract 10 ======== 11 12 This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM 13 is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides 14 type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of 15 representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code 16 representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation 17 strategy. 18 19 Introduction 20 ============ 21 22 The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different 23 forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation 24 (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human 25 readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a 26 powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler 27 transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug 28 and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are 29 all equivalent. This document describes the human readable 30 representation and notation. 31 32 The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while 33 being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be 34 a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that 35 high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how 36 microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to 37 be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as 38 the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it 39 can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of 40 the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value 41 instead of a memory location. 42 43 .. _wellformed: 44 45 Well-Formedness 46 --------------- 47 48 It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM 49 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts 50 and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following 51 instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed: 52 53 .. code-block:: llvm 54 55 %x = add i32 1, %x 56 57 because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The 58 LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to 59 verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically 60 run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer 61 before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier 62 pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser. 63 64 .. _identifiers: 65 66 Identifiers 67 =========== 68 69 LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global 70 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'`` 71 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the 72 ``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for 73 identifiers, for different purposes: 74 75 #. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their 76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``, 77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is 78 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other 79 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special 80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII 81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can 82 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix 83 can be used on global variables to suppress mangling. 84 #. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with 85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``. 86 #. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below. 87 88 LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers 89 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set 90 of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty. 91 Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up 92 with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table 93 conflicts. 94 95 Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other 96 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``', 97 '``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``', 98 '``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict 99 with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character 100 (``'%'`` or ``'@'``). 101 102 Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable 103 '``%X``' by 8: 104 105 The easy way: 106 107 .. code-block:: llvm 108 109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8 110 111 After strength reduction: 112 113 .. code-block:: llvm 114 115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3 116 117 And the hard way: 118 119 .. code-block:: llvm 120 121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0 122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1 123 %result = add i32 %1, %1 124 125 This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important 126 lexical features of LLVM: 127 128 #. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line. 129 #. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is 130 not assigned to a named value. 131 #. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function 132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed 133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the 134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are 135 named, then it will get number 0. 136 137 It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When 138 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment 139 that defines the type and name of value produced. 140 141 High Level Structure 142 ==================== 143 144 Module Structure 145 ---------------- 146 147 LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a 148 translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of 149 functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be 150 combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and 151 global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges 152 symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module: 153 154 .. code-block:: llvm 155 156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant. 157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00" 158 159 ; External declaration of the puts function 160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind 161 162 ; Definition of main function 163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()* 164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8 *... 165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0 166 167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout. 168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210) 169 ret i32 0 170 } 171 172 ; Named metadata 173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"} 174 !foo = !{!0} 175 176 This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named 177 "``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a 178 :ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and 179 :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``". 180 181 In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both 182 functions and global variables are global values). Global values are 183 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer 184 to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the 185 following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`. 186 187 .. _linkage: 188 189 Linkage Types 190 ------------- 191 192 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of 193 linkage: 194 195 ``private`` 196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly 197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking 198 code into a module with an private global value may cause the 199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the 200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This 201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file. 202 ``internal`` 203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol 204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This 205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C. 206 ``available_externally`` 207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into 208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's 209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to 210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other 211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the 212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals 213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at 214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is 215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations. 216 ``linkonce`` 217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of 218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement 219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must 220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the 221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later. 222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note 223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to 224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't 225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition 226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger 227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use 228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage. 229 ``weak`` 230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce`` 231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may 232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak" 233 in C source code. 234 ``common`` 235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they 236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at 237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the 238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if 239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section, 240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked 241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have 242 common linkage. 243 244 .. _linkage_appending: 245 246 ``appending`` 247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of 248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending 249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended 250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the 251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when 252 .o files are linked. 253 ``extern_weak`` 254 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the 255 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null 256 instead of being an undefined reference. 257 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr`` 258 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two 259 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as 260 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the 261 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the 262 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the 263 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage 264 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions. 265 ``external`` 266 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally 267 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to 268 resolve external symbol references. 269 270 It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type 271 other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``. 272 273 .. _callingconv: 274 275 Calling Conventions 276 ------------------- 277 278 LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and 279 :ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention 280 specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic 281 caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined. 282 The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be 283 added in the future: 284 285 "``ccc``" - The C calling convention 286 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention 287 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling 288 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some 289 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of 290 the function (as does normal C). 291 "``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention 292 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible 293 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention 294 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast 295 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally 296 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only 297 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is 298 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not 299 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly 300 match the prototype of the function definition. 301 "``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention 302 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as 303 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not 304 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers 305 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side. 306 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the 307 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the 308 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function 309 calls for inlining. 310 "``cc 10``" - GHC convention 311 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by 312 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_. 313 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this 314 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should 315 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an 316 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often 317 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the 318 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following 319 limitations: 320 321 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No 322 floating point types are supported. 323 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6 324 floating point parameters. 325 326 This calling convention supports `tail call 327 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the 328 caller and callee are using it. 329 "``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention 330 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by 331 the `High-Performance Erlang 332 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the* 333 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP 334 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more 335 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling 336 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling 337 convention properly supports `tail call 338 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the 339 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning* 340 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently 341 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers. 342 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64 343 bit). 344 "``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention 345 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT 346 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the 347 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the 348 platform's customary return register. 349 "``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching 350 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code 351 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call 352 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically 353 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to 354 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records 355 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`. 356 "``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention 357 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as 358 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C` 359 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it 360 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the 361 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the 362 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, 363 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't 364 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers. 365 366 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for 367 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers 368 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller. 369 370 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions 371 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece 372 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to 373 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved 374 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The 375 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling 376 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for 377 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are 378 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be 379 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc` 380 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call. 381 382 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC 383 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time. 384 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to 385 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used 386 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only 387 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the 388 future. 389 "``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention 390 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less 391 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling 392 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how 393 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of 394 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and 395 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If 396 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be 397 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values 398 returned in callee-saved registers. 399 400 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for 401 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves 402 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs). 403 404 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions 405 that don't need to call out to any other functions. 406 407 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be 408 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered 409 experimental at this time. 410 "``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions 411 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access 412 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization 413 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access 414 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific 415 sequence. 416 417 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by 418 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are 419 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks). 420 421 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on 422 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of 423 caller/callee-saved registers. 424 425 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set 426 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`. 427 428 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for 429 RDI and RAX. 430 "``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention 431 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing 432 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific 433 calling conventions start at 64. 434 435 More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to 436 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent 437 convention. 438 439 .. _visibilitystyles: 440 441 Visibility Styles 442 ----------------- 443 444 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility 445 styles: 446 447 "``default``" - Default style 448 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility 449 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in 450 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden. 451 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible 452 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external 453 linkage" in the language. 454 "``hidden``" - Hidden style 455 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the 456 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden 457 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the 458 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared 459 library) can reference it directly. 460 "``protected``" - Protected style 461 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be 462 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the 463 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol 464 cannot be overridden by another module. 465 466 A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default`` 467 visibility. 468 469 .. _dllstorageclass: 470 471 DLL Storage Classes 472 ------------------- 473 474 All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following 475 DLL storage class: 476 477 ``dllimport`` 478 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via 479 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the 480 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by 481 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. 482 ``dllexport`` 483 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer 484 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On 485 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining 486 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class 487 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know 488 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol. 489 490 .. _tls_model: 491 492 Thread Local Storage Models 493 --------------------------- 494 495 A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will 496 not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the 497 variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a 498 TLS model may be specified: 499 500 ``localdynamic`` 501 For variables that are only used within the current shared library. 502 ``initialexec`` 503 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically. 504 ``localexec`` 505 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it. 506 507 If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used. 508 509 The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For 510 Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for 511 more information on under which circumstances the different models may 512 be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified 513 model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made. 514 515 A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how 516 the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee. 517 518 For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls 519 flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code. 520 521 .. _namedtypes: 522 523 Structure Types 524 --------------- 525 526 LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure 527 types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types 528 are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used 529 to forward declare a type that is not yet available. 530 531 An example of an identified structure specification is: 532 533 .. code-block:: llvm 534 535 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 } 536 537 Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only 538 literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM. 539 540 .. _globalvars: 541 542 Global Variables 543 ---------------- 544 545 Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time 546 instead of run-time. 547 548 Global variable definitions must be initialized. 549 550 Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which 551 case they don't have an initializer. 552 553 Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section 554 to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified. 555 556 A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that 557 the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better 558 optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only 559 section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime 560 initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the 561 variable. 562 563 LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked 564 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This 565 capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the 566 program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that 567 optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation 568 units that do not include the definition. 569 570 As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope 571 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables 572 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a 573 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through 574 pointers. 575 576 Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates 577 that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked 578 like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same 579 initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be 580 merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant 581 whose address is significant. 582 583 A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific 584 numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces 585 may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target 586 instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space 587 is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes. 588 589 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the 590 target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified. 591 Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary 592 support. 593 594 By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global 595 variables defined within the module are not modified from their 596 initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is 597 true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the 598 module, including those with external linkage or appearing in 599 ``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed 600 by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``. 601 602 An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a 603 power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the 604 alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels 605 convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced 606 to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed 607 to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this 608 case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could 609 assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to 610 iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this 611 iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``. 612 613 Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`. 614 615 Variables and aliases can have a 616 :ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`. 617 618 Syntax:: 619 620 [@<GlobalVarName> =] [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] 621 [unnamed_addr] [AddrSpace] [ExternallyInitialized] 622 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>] 623 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]] 624 [, align <Alignment>] 625 626 For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space 627 with an initializer, section, and alignment: 628 629 .. code-block:: llvm 630 631 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4 632 633 The following example just declares a global variable 634 635 .. code-block:: llvm 636 637 @G = external global i32 638 639 The following example defines a thread-local global with the 640 ``initialexec`` TLS model: 641 642 .. code-block:: llvm 643 644 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4 645 646 .. _functionstructure: 647 648 Functions 649 --------- 650 651 LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an 652 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility 653 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, 654 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, 655 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional 656 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function 657 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter 658 attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`, 659 an optional section, an optional alignment, 660 an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`, 661 an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, 662 an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`, 663 an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`, 664 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`, 665 an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace. 666 667 LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an 668 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility 669 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, 670 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, 671 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional 672 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function 673 name, a possibly empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional 674 :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, 675 and an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`. 676 677 A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control 678 Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label 679 (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions, 680 and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or 681 function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an 682 implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for 683 unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function 684 entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0", 685 then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc. 686 687 The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is 688 immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed 689 to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to 690 the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no 691 predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`. 692 693 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the 694 target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified. 695 Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT. 696 697 An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present, 698 or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set 699 by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment 700 is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much 701 alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2. 702 703 If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not 704 be significant and two identical functions can be merged. 705 706 Syntax:: 707 708 define [linkage] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass] 709 [cconv] [ret attrs] 710 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list]) 711 [unnamed_addr] [fn Attrs] [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]] 712 [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant] [prologue Constant] 713 [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... } 714 715 The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each 716 argument is of the following form: 717 718 Syntax:: 719 720 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name] 721 722 723 .. _langref_aliases: 724 725 Aliases 726 ------- 727 728 Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They 729 are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position. 730 731 Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a 732 constant expression. 733 734 Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional 735 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class 736 <dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`. 737 738 Syntax:: 739 740 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [unnamed_addr] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee> 741 742 The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``, 743 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers 744 might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased. 745 746 Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as 747 the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point 748 to the same content. 749 750 Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which 751 some can only be checked when producing an object file: 752 753 * The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly 754 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used. 755 756 * No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the 757 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an 758 object file. 759 760 * No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that 761 would require a relocation, which is not possible. 762 763 .. _langref_comdats: 764 765 Comdats 766 ------- 767 768 Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality. 769 770 Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that 771 specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses 772 that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their 773 aliasee computes to, if any. 774 775 Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should 776 choose between keys in two different object files. 777 778 Syntax:: 779 780 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind 781 782 The selection kind must be one of the following: 783 784 ``any`` 785 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary. 786 ``exactmatch`` 787 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the 788 same data. 789 ``largest`` 790 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key. 791 ``noduplicates`` 792 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist. 793 ``samesize`` 794 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the 795 same amount of data. 796 797 Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs and ELF only supports 798 ``any`` as a selection kind. 799 800 Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if 801 the COMDAT key's section is the largest: 802 803 .. code-block:: llvm 804 805 $foo = comdat largest 806 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo) 807 808 define void @bar() comdat($foo) { 809 ret void 810 } 811 812 As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as 813 the global name: 814 815 .. code-block:: llvm 816 817 $foo = comdat any 818 @foo = global i32 2, comdat 819 820 821 In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind 822 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol 823 and another COMDAT section with selection kind 824 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT 825 section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol. 826 827 There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object. 828 It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when 829 targeting COFF. 830 The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine 831 which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind. 832 Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the 833 linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed 834 if a collision occurs in the symbol table. 835 836 The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results. 837 For example: 838 839 .. code-block:: llvm 840 841 $foo = comdat any 842 $bar = comdat any 843 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo) 844 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar) 845 846 From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections 847 with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different 848 COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by 849 sections. 850 851 Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may 852 create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using 853 COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals 854 in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections` 855 is supplied to `llc`). 856 857 .. _namedmetadatastructure: 858 859 Named Metadata 860 -------------- 861 862 Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata 863 nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid 864 operands for a named metadata. 865 866 #. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the 867 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for 868 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes 869 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name. 870 871 Syntax:: 872 873 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata. 874 !0 = !{!"zero"} 875 !1 = !{!"one"} 876 !2 = !{!"two"} 877 ; A named metadata. 878 !name = !{!0, !1, !2} 879 880 .. _paramattrs: 881 882 Parameter Attributes 883 -------------------- 884 885 The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of 886 *parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are 887 used to communicate additional information about the result or 888 parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part 889 of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different 890 parameter attributes can have the same function type. 891 892 Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified. 893 If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated. 894 For example: 895 896 .. code-block:: llvm 897 898 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...) 899 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext) 900 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char() 901 902 Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``, 903 ``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list. 904 905 Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined: 906 907 ``zeroext`` 908 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return 909 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's 910 ABI (which is usually 32-bits, but is 8-bits for a i1 on x86-64) by 911 the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value). 912 ``signext`` 913 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return 914 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's 915 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or 916 the callee (for a return value). 917 ``inreg`` 918 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated 919 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for 920 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as 921 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between 922 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is 923 target-specific. 924 ``byval`` 925 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by 926 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of 927 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee 928 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only 929 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass 930 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to 931 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the 932 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to 933 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return 934 values. 935 936 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the 937 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to 938 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call 939 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator 940 makes a target-specific assumption. 941 942 .. _attr_inalloca: 943 944 ``inalloca`` 945 946 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the 947 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must 948 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction. 949 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the 950 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca`` 951 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory. 952 953 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because 954 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be 955 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument 956 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The 957 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of 958 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors 959 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers. 960 961 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have 962 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the 963 results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack 964 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it 965 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore 966 <int_stackrestore>`. 967 968 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this 969 attribute. 970 971 ``sret`` 972 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a 973 structure that is the return value of the function in the source 974 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid: 975 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee 976 not to trap and to be properly aligned. This may only be applied to 977 the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return 978 values. 979 980 ``align <n>`` 981 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to 982 have the specified alignment. 983 984 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the 985 ``byval`` attribute. 986 987 .. _noalias: 988 989 ``noalias`` 990 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values 991 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also 992 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not 993 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value 994 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the 995 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met. 996 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in 997 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`. 998 999 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar 1000 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments. 1001 1002 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful, 1003 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias`` 1004 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute 1005 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias`` 1006 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation 1007 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the 1008 storage for any other object accessible to the caller. 1009 1010 ``nocapture`` 1011 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the 1012 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid 1013 attribute for return values. 1014 1015 .. _nest: 1016 1017 ``nest`` 1018 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the 1019 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid 1020 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter. 1021 1022 ``returned`` 1023 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return 1024 value. This is an optimization hint to the code generator when generating 1025 the caller, allowing tail call optimization and omission of register saves 1026 and restores in some cases; it is not checked or enforced when generating 1027 the callee. The parameter and the function return type must be valid 1028 operands for the :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a 1029 valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter. 1030 1031 ``nonnull`` 1032 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This 1033 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not 1034 checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer 1035 passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer 1036 is non-null. 1037 1038 ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` 1039 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This 1040 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that 1041 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of 1042 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided 1043 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the 1044 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply 1045 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an 1046 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in 1047 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space). 1048 1049 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` 1050 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both 1051 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same 1052 time. All non-null pointers tagged with 1053 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``. 1054 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that 1055 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``, 1056 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` 1057 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` 1058 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and 1059 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to 1060 pointer typed parameters. 1061 1062 .. _gc: 1063 1064 Garbage Collector Strategy Names 1065 -------------------------------- 1066 1067 Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a 1068 string: 1069 1070 .. code-block:: llvm 1071 1072 define void @f() gc "name" { ... } 1073 1074 The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM 1075 <builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC 1076 strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the 1077 named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a 1078 garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code 1079 which can interoperate with a collector provided externally. 1080 1081 .. _prefixdata: 1082 1083 Prefix Data 1084 ----------- 1085 1086 Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code 1087 generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint. 1088 The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate 1089 language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it 1090 available through the function pointer while still allowing the 1091 function pointer to be called. 1092 1093 To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the 1094 function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference 1095 index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of 1096 the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated 1097 with a single ``i32``, 1098 1099 .. code-block:: llvm 1100 1101 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... } 1102 1103 The prefix data can be referenced as, 1104 1105 .. code-block:: llvm 1106 1107 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32* 1108 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1 1109 %b = load i32, i32* %a 1110 1111 Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable 1112 of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the 1113 beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size 1114 of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the 1115 function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the 1116 function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix 1117 data. 1118 1119 A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics 1120 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the 1121 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file. 1122 1123 .. _prologuedata: 1124 1125 Prologue Data 1126 ------------- 1127 1128 The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to 1129 be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling 1130 function hot-patching and instrumentation. 1131 1132 To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must 1133 have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of 1134 bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the 1135 module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding 1136 the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows 1137 the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function 1138 definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this 1139 makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent. 1140 1141 A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``, 1142 which encodes the ``nop`` instruction: 1143 1144 .. code-block:: llvm 1145 1146 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... } 1147 1148 Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction 1149 which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the 1150 x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``: 1151 1152 .. code-block:: llvm 1153 1154 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }> 1155 1156 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... } 1157 1158 A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics 1159 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the 1160 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file. 1161 1162 .. _personalityfn: 1163 1164 Personality Function 1165 -------------------- 1166 1167 The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function 1168 to use for exception handling. 1169 1170 .. _attrgrp: 1171 1172 Attribute Groups 1173 ---------------- 1174 1175 Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within 1176 the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of 1177 functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a 1178 ``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute 1179 group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file. 1180 1181 An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an 1182 object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer 1183 to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the 1184 different groups are merged. 1185 1186 Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be 1187 inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions: 1188 1189 .. code-block:: llvm 1190 1191 ; Target-independent attributes: 1192 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 } 1193 1194 ; Target-dependent attributes: 1195 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" } 1196 1197 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse". 1198 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... } 1199 1200 .. _fnattrs: 1201 1202 Function Attributes 1203 ------------------- 1204 1205 Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about 1206 a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the 1207 function, not of the function type, so functions with different function 1208 attributes can have the same function type. 1209 1210 Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified. 1211 If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For 1212 example: 1213 1214 .. code-block:: llvm 1215 1216 define void @f() noinline { ... } 1217 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... } 1218 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... } 1219 define void @f() optsize { ... } 1220 1221 ``alignstack(<n>)`` 1222 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and 1223 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer. 1224 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in 1225 parentheses. 1226 ``alwaysinline`` 1227 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline 1228 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active 1229 inlining size threshold for this caller. 1230 ``builtin`` 1231 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be 1232 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration 1233 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for 1234 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin`` 1235 attribute. 1236 ``cold`` 1237 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When 1238 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold 1239 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low 1240 weight. 1241 ``convergent`` 1242 This attribute indicates that the callee is dependent on a convergent 1243 thread execution pattern under certain parallel execution models. 1244 Transformations that are execution model agnostic may not make the execution 1245 of a convergent operation control dependent on any additional values. 1246 ``inaccessiblememonly`` 1247 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that 1248 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form 1249 of ``readnone``. 1250 ``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly`` 1251 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is 1252 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to 1253 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly`` 1254 ``inlinehint`` 1255 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that 1256 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in 1257 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the 1258 inliner. 1259 ``jumptable`` 1260 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a 1261 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken 1262 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the 1263 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates 1264 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends 1265 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with 1266 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``. 1267 ``minsize`` 1268 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator 1269 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small 1270 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime 1271 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code. 1272 ``naked`` 1273 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the 1274 function. This can have very system-specific consequences. 1275 ``nobuiltin`` 1276 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as 1277 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it 1278 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless 1279 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites 1280 and on function declarations and definitions. 1281 ``noduplicate`` 1282 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be 1283 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved 1284 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within 1285 its parent function. 1286 1287 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still 1288 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not 1289 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has 1290 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original 1291 call is dead after inlining. 1292 ``noimplicitfloat`` 1293 This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions. 1294 ``noinline`` 1295 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this 1296 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together 1297 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute. 1298 ``nonlazybind`` 1299 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This 1300 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program 1301 startup time if the function is not called during program startup. 1302 ``noredzone`` 1303 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a 1304 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it. 1305 ``noreturn`` 1306 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns 1307 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the 1308 function ever does dynamically return. 1309 ``norecurse`` 1310 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself 1311 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces 1312 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse. 1313 ``nounwind`` 1314 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an 1315 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime 1316 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still 1317 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes 1318 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such 1319 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics. 1320 ``optnone`` 1321 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip 1322 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes. 1323 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector. 1324 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline`` 1325 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible 1326 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute. 1327 1328 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on 1329 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller. 1330 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid 1331 candidates for inlining into the body of this function. 1332 ``optsize`` 1333 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator 1334 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low, 1335 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as 1336 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance. 1337 ``readnone`` 1338 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its 1339 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments, 1340 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing 1341 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to 1342 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments 1343 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible 1344 to callers. This means that it cannot unwind exceptions by calling 1345 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods. 1346 1347 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not 1348 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the 1349 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers. 1350 ``readonly`` 1351 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write 1352 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise 1353 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to 1354 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read 1355 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always 1356 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when 1357 called with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot 1358 unwind an exception by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing 1359 methods. 1360 1361 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write 1362 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that 1363 the pointer points to. 1364 ``argmemonly`` 1365 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are 1366 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments, 1367 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the 1368 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function 1369 arguments. 1370 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute 1371 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments. 1372 ``returns_twice`` 1373 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C 1374 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables 1375 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these 1376 functions. 1377 ``safestack`` 1378 This attribute indicates that 1379 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_ 1380 protection is enabled for this function. 1381 1382 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a 1383 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an 1384 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting 1385 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute. 1386 ``sanitize_address`` 1387 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks 1388 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function. 1389 ``sanitize_memory`` 1390 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection 1391 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function. 1392 ``sanitize_thread`` 1393 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks 1394 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function. 1395 ``ssp`` 1396 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack 1397 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value 1398 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon 1399 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A 1400 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors 1401 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with: 1402 1403 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8). 1404 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``. 1405 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than 1406 ``ssp-buffer-size``. 1407 1408 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged 1409 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard. 1410 1411 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a 1412 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting 1413 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute. 1414 ``sspreq`` 1415 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a 1416 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function 1417 attribute. 1418 1419 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged 1420 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard. 1421 The specific layout rules are: 1422 1423 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays 1424 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector. 1425 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays 1426 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector. 1427 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the 1428 protector. 1429 1430 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a 1431 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an 1432 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have 1433 an ``sspreq`` attribute. 1434 ``sspstrong`` 1435 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing 1436 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when 1437 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic 1438 will enable protectors for functions with: 1439 1440 - Arrays of any size and type 1441 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type. 1442 - Calls to alloca(). 1443 - Local variables that have had their address taken. 1444 1445 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged 1446 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard. 1447 The specific layout rules are: 1448 1449 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays 1450 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector. 1451 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays 1452 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector. 1453 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the 1454 protector. 1455 1456 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute. 1457 1458 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a 1459 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the 1460 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute. 1461 ``"thunk"`` 1462 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other 1463 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for 1464 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to 1465 match the thunk target prototype. 1466 ``uwtable`` 1467 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that 1468 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can 1469 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for 1470 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation 1471 units. 1472 1473 1474 .. _opbundles: 1475 1476 Operand Bundles 1477 --------------- 1478 1479 Note: operand bundles are a work in progress, and they should be 1480 considered experimental at this time. 1481 1482 Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated 1483 with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and 1484 ``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is 1485 incorrect and will change program semantics. 1486 1487 Syntax:: 1488 1489 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']' 1490 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')' 1491 bundle operand ::= SSA value 1492 tag ::= string constant 1493 1494 Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a 1495 given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds 1496 of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles 1497 are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the 1498 callee being dispatched to. 1499 1500 Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support 1501 runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While 1502 the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag, 1503 there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand 1504 bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions 1505 are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As 1506 long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these 1507 restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the 1508 operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it. 1509 1510 - The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown 1511 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee. 1512 - Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write 1513 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is 1514 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overriden with 1515 callsite specific attributes. 1516 - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation 1517 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as 1518 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties. 1519 1520 More specific types of operand bundles are described below. 1521 1522 Deoptimization Operand Bundles 1523 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 1524 1525 Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"`` 1526 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate 1527 "safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be 1528 used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the 1529 specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand 1530 bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is 1531 out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves 1532 rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames. 1533 1534 From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make 1535 the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read 1536 through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not 1537 otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization 1538 operand bundles do not capture their operands except during 1539 deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the 1540 compiled frame. 1541 1542 The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization 1543 operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site 1544 involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining 1545 through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to 1546 appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The 1547 inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization 1548 continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body. 1549 E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example 1550 1551 .. code-block:: llvm 1552 1553 define void @f() { 1554 call void @x() ;; no deopt state 1555 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ] 1556 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ] 1557 ret void 1558 } 1559 1560 define void @g() { 1561 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ] 1562 ret void 1563 } 1564 1565 will result in 1566 1567 .. code-block:: llvm 1568 1569 define void @g() { 1570 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state 1571 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ] 1572 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ] 1573 ret void 1574 } 1575 1576 It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the 1577 deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the 1578 caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is 1579 semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization 1580 continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation. 1581 1582 Funclet Operand Bundles 1583 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 1584 1585 Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"`` 1586 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site 1587 is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one 1588 ``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have 1589 exactly one bundle operand. 1590 1591 .. _moduleasm: 1592 1593 Module-Level Inline Assembly 1594 ---------------------------- 1595 1596 Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds 1597 to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally 1598 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated 1599 in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple: 1600 1601 .. code-block:: llvm 1602 1603 module asm "inline asm code goes here" 1604 module asm "more can go here" 1605 1606 The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable 1607 characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the 1608 two digit hex code for the number. 1609 1610 Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler 1611 (unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file. 1612 1613 .. _langref_datalayout: 1614 1615 Data Layout 1616 ----------- 1617 1618 A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies 1619 how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is 1620 simply: 1621 1622 .. code-block:: llvm 1623 1624 target datalayout = "layout specification" 1625 1626 The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications 1627 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts 1628 with a letter and may include other information after the letter to 1629 define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are 1630 as follows: 1631 1632 ``E`` 1633 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is, 1634 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address 1635 location. 1636 ``e`` 1637 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That 1638 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address 1639 location. 1640 ``S<size>`` 1641 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment 1642 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack 1643 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment 1644 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack 1645 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any 1646 alignment promotions. 1647 ``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>`` 1648 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and 1649 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. All sizes are in 1650 bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified, 1651 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be 1652 in the range [1,2^23). 1653 ``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>`` 1654 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit 1655 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23). 1656 ``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>`` 1657 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit 1658 ``<size>``. 1659 ``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>`` 1660 This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit 1661 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target 1662 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80 1663 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some 1664 targets. 1665 ``a:<abi>:<pref>`` 1666 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type. 1667 ``m:<mangling>`` 1668 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. The 1669 options are 1670 1671 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix. 1672 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix. 1673 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other 1674 symbols get a ``_`` prefix. 1675 * ``w``: Windows COFF prefix: Similar to Mach-O, but stdcall and fastcall 1676 functions also get a suffix based on the frame size. 1677 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF prefix: Similar to Windows COFF, but use a ``_`` 1678 prefix for ``__cdecl`` functions. 1679 ``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...`` 1680 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in 1681 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC, 1682 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of 1683 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations 1684 efficiently. 1685 1686 On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the 1687 ``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:`` 1688 should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``. 1689 1690 When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a 1691 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by 1692 the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default 1693 specifications are given in this list: 1694 1695 - ``E`` - big endian 1696 - ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment. 1697 - ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the 1698 same as the default address space. 1699 - ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified 1700 - ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned 1701 - ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned 1702 - ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned 1703 - ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned 1704 - ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred 1705 alignment of 64-bits 1706 - ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned 1707 - ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned 1708 - ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned 1709 - ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned 1710 - ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned 1711 - ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned 1712 - ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned 1713 1714 When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the 1715 following rules: 1716 1717 #. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications, 1718 that specification is used. 1719 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then 1720 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the 1721 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than 1722 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example, 1723 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the 1724 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the 1725 alignment of i64 (largest specified). 1726 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the 1727 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will 1728 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be 1729 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example. 1730 1731 The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect. 1732 Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment 1733 the code generator should use. 1734 1735 Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what 1736 the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the 1737 mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches 1738 what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR 1739 that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you 1740 don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to 1741 generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate 1742 accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to 1743 these default specifications. 1744 1745 .. _langref_triple: 1746 1747 Target Triple 1748 ------------- 1749 1750 A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target 1751 host. The syntax for the target triple is simply: 1752 1753 .. code-block:: llvm 1754 1755 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0" 1756 1757 The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited 1758 by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are: 1759 1760 :: 1761 1762 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM 1763 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT 1764 1765 This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates 1766 code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the 1767 command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option. 1768 1769 .. _pointeraliasing: 1770 1771 Pointer Aliasing Rules 1772 ---------------------- 1773 1774 Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with 1775 an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is 1776 undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according 1777 to the following rules: 1778 1779 - A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any 1780 value it is *based* on. 1781 - An address of a global variable is associated with the address range 1782 of the variable's storage. 1783 - The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the 1784 address range of the allocated storage. 1785 - A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no 1786 address. 1787 - An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from 1788 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address 1789 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by 1790 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses 1791 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM. 1792 1793 A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the 1794 following rules: 1795 1796 - A pointer value formed from a ``getelementptr`` operation is *based* 1797 on the first value operand of the ``getelementptr``. 1798 - The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the 1799 ``bitcast``. 1800 - A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer 1801 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of 1802 the pointer's value. 1803 - The "*based* on" relationship is transitive. 1804 1805 Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the 1806 definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker. 1807 1808 LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a 1809 ``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from 1810 which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first 1811 operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and 1812 alignment of the store. 1813 1814 Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka 1815 ``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR. 1816 :ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information 1817 which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based 1818 alias analysis. 1819 1820 .. _volatile: 1821 1822 Volatile Memory Accesses 1823 ------------------------ 1824 1825 Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s, 1826 :ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be 1827 marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of 1828 volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other 1829 volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile 1830 operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's 1831 "volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior. 1832 1833 IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into 1834 llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are 1835 flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge 1836 target-legal volatile load/store instructions. 1837 1838 .. admonition:: Rationale 1839 1840 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported 1841 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C 1842 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native 1843 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The 1844 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally 1845 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations 1846 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language. 1847 1848 .. _memmodel: 1849 1850 Memory Model for Concurrent Operations 1851 -------------------------------------- 1852 1853 The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of 1854 execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are 1855 platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior 1856 in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model. 1857 1858 For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`. 1859 1860 We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order 1861 that 1862 1863 - Is a superset of single-thread program order, and 1864 - When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to 1865 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific 1866 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining, 1867 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering 1868 Constraints <ordering>`). 1869 1870 Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges 1871 between a thread and signals executing inside that thread. 1872 1873 Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic 1874 loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by 1875 (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic 1876 stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this 1877 section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the 1878 initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write 1879 of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte` 1880 may see any write to the same byte, except: 1881 1882 - If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and 1883 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then 1884 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`. 1885 - If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then 1886 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`. 1887 1888 Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows: 1889 1890 - If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is 1891 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in 1892 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave 1893 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread 1894 synchronization.) 1895 - Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before 1896 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte. 1897 - Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write, 1898 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write. 1899 - Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may 1900 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic 1901 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional 1902 constraints on how the choice is made. 1903 - Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``. 1904 1905 R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This 1906 implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without** 1907 the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the 1908 semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more 1909 than one instruction to read the series of bytes. 1910 1911 Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this 1912 model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what 1913 is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte 1914 which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general. 1915 (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read 1916 from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see 1917 exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.) 1918 1919 .. _ordering: 1920 1921 Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints 1922 ---------------------------------- 1923 1924 Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`, 1925 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`, 1926 :ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take 1927 ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on 1928 the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed 1929 from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these 1930 descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec 1931 references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`). 1932 :ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat 1933 differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's 1934 documentation for details. 1935 1936 For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the 1937 :doc:`Atomics`. 1938 1939 ``unordered`` 1940 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before 1941 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote 1942 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model 1943 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be 1944 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough 1945 to make them atomic in any interesting way. 1946 ``monotonic`` 1947 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single 1948 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each 1949 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the 1950 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification 1951 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program 1952 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic 1953 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and 1954 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification 1955 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read 1956 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later 1957 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's 1958 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or 1959 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written 1960 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally 1961 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see 1962 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x 1963 ``memory_order_relaxed``. 1964 ``acquire`` 1965 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a 1966 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation. 1967 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``. 1968 ``release`` 1969 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation 1970 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire`` 1971 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a 1972 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release 1973 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x 1974 ``memory_order_release``. 1975 ``acq_rel`` (acquire+release) 1976 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its 1977 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``. 1978 ``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent) 1979 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an 1980 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only 1981 writes), there is a global total order on all 1982 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is 1983 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the 1984 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each 1985 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the 1986 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x 1987 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile. 1988 1989 .. _singlethread: 1990 1991 If an atomic operation is marked ``singlethread``, it only *synchronizes 1992 with* or participates in modification and seq\_cst total orderings with 1993 other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal 1994 handlers). 1995 1996 .. _fastmath: 1997 1998 Fast-Math Flags 1999 --------------- 2000 2001 LLVM IR floating-point binary ops (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`, 2002 :ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`, 2003 :ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) have the following flags that can 2004 be set to enable otherwise unsafe floating point operations 2005 2006 ``nnan`` 2007 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not 2008 NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over 2009 NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined. 2010 2011 ``ninf`` 2012 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not 2013 +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over 2014 +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined. 2015 2016 ``nsz`` 2017 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero 2018 argument or result as insignificant. 2019 2020 ``arcp`` 2021 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an 2022 argument rather than perform division. 2023 2024 ``fast`` 2025 Fast - Allow algebraically equivalent transformations that may 2026 dramatically change results in floating point (e.g. reassociate). This 2027 flag implies all the others. 2028 2029 .. _uselistorder: 2030 2031 Use-list Order Directives 2032 ------------------------- 2033 2034 Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the 2035 order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of 2036 indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced 2037 value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes. 2038 2039 Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not 2040 instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at 2041 function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block. 2042 2043 If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions, 2044 ``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their 2045 function's scope. 2046 2047 :Syntax: 2048 2049 :: 2050 2051 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> } 2052 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> } 2053 2054 :Examples: 2055 2056 :: 2057 2058 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) { 2059 entry: 2060 ; ... instructions ... 2061 bb: 2062 ; ... instructions ... 2063 2064 ; At function scope. 2065 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 } 2066 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 } 2067 } 2068 2069 ; At global scope. 2070 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 } 2071 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 } 2072 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 } 2073 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 } 2074 2075 .. _typesystem: 2076 2077 Type System 2078 =========== 2079 2080 The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the 2081 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of 2082 optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation 2083 directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the 2084 transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the 2085 generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are 2086 not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations. 2087 2088 .. _t_void: 2089 2090 Void Type 2091 --------- 2092 2093 :Overview: 2094 2095 2096 The void type does not represent any value and has no size. 2097 2098 :Syntax: 2099 2100 2101 :: 2102 2103 void 2104 2105 2106 .. _t_function: 2107 2108 Function Type 2109 ------------- 2110 2111 :Overview: 2112 2113 2114 The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a 2115 return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function 2116 type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>` 2117 and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types. 2118 2119 :Syntax: 2120 2121 :: 2122 2123 <returntype> (<parameter list>) 2124 2125 ...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type 2126 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which 2127 indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable 2128 argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument 2129 handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type 2130 except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`. 2131 2132 :Examples: 2133 2134 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2135 | ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` | 2136 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2137 | ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. | 2138 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2139 | ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. | 2140 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2141 | ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values | 2142 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2143 2144 .. _t_firstclass: 2145 2146 First Class Types 2147 ----------------- 2148 2149 The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important. 2150 Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by 2151 instructions. 2152 2153 .. _t_single_value: 2154 2155 Single Value Types 2156 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 2157 2158 These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective. 2159 2160 .. _t_integer: 2161 2162 Integer Type 2163 """""""""""" 2164 2165 :Overview: 2166 2167 The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an 2168 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1 2169 bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified. 2170 2171 :Syntax: 2172 2173 :: 2174 2175 iN 2176 2177 The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N`` 2178 value. 2179 2180 Examples: 2181 ********* 2182 2183 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+ 2184 | ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. | 2185 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+ 2186 | ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. | 2187 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+ 2188 | ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. | 2189 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+ 2190 2191 .. _t_floating: 2192 2193 Floating Point Types 2194 """""""""""""""""""" 2195 2196 .. list-table:: 2197 :header-rows: 1 2198 2199 * - Type 2200 - Description 2201 2202 * - ``half`` 2203 - 16-bit floating point value 2204 2205 * - ``float`` 2206 - 32-bit floating point value 2207 2208 * - ``double`` 2209 - 64-bit floating point value 2210 2211 * - ``fp128`` 2212 - 128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa) 2213 2214 * - ``x86_fp80`` 2215 - 80-bit floating point value (X87) 2216 2217 * - ``ppc_fp128`` 2218 - 128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits) 2219 2220 X86_mmx Type 2221 """""""""""" 2222 2223 :Overview: 2224 2225 The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86 2226 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and 2227 return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX 2228 instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments 2229 and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants 2230 of this type. 2231 2232 :Syntax: 2233 2234 :: 2235 2236 x86_mmx 2237 2238 2239 .. _t_pointer: 2240 2241 Pointer Type 2242 """""""""""" 2243 2244 :Overview: 2245 2246 The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are 2247 commonly used to reference objects in memory. 2248 2249 Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the 2250 numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default 2251 address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces 2252 are target-specific. 2253 2254 Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it 2255 permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead. 2256 2257 :Syntax: 2258 2259 :: 2260 2261 <type> * 2262 2263 :Examples: 2264 2265 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2266 | ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. | 2267 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2268 | ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. | 2269 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2270 | ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. | 2271 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2272 2273 .. _t_vector: 2274 2275 Vector Type 2276 """"""""""" 2277 2278 :Overview: 2279 2280 A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of 2281 elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are 2282 operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type 2283 requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data 2284 type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`. 2285 2286 :Syntax: 2287 2288 :: 2289 2290 < <# elements> x <elementtype> > 2291 2292 The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0; 2293 elementtype may be any integer, floating point or pointer type. Vectors 2294 of size zero are not allowed. 2295 2296 :Examples: 2297 2298 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+ 2299 | ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. | 2300 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+ 2301 | ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. | 2302 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+ 2303 | ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. | 2304 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+ 2305 | ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. | 2306 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+ 2307 2308 .. _t_label: 2309 2310 Label Type 2311 ^^^^^^^^^^ 2312 2313 :Overview: 2314 2315 The label type represents code labels. 2316 2317 :Syntax: 2318 2319 :: 2320 2321 label 2322 2323 .. _t_token: 2324 2325 Token Type 2326 ^^^^^^^^^^ 2327 2328 :Overview: 2329 2330 The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction 2331 but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it. 2332 As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or 2333 :ref:`select <i_select>` of type token. 2334 2335 :Syntax: 2336 2337 :: 2338 2339 token 2340 2341 2342 2343 .. _t_metadata: 2344 2345 Metadata Type 2346 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 2347 2348 :Overview: 2349 2350 The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be 2351 created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments. 2352 2353 :Syntax: 2354 2355 :: 2356 2357 metadata 2358 2359 .. _t_aggregate: 2360 2361 Aggregate Types 2362 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 2363 2364 Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple 2365 member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are 2366 aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be 2367 aggregate types. 2368 2369 .. _t_array: 2370 2371 Array Type 2372 """""""""" 2373 2374 :Overview: 2375 2376 The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements 2377 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of 2378 elements) and an underlying data type. 2379 2380 :Syntax: 2381 2382 :: 2383 2384 [<# elements> x <elementtype>] 2385 2386 The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may 2387 be any type with a size. 2388 2389 :Examples: 2390 2391 +------------------+--------------------------------------+ 2392 | ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. | 2393 +------------------+--------------------------------------+ 2394 | ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. | 2395 +------------------+--------------------------------------+ 2396 | ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. | 2397 +------------------+--------------------------------------+ 2398 2399 Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays: 2400 2401 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+ 2402 | ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. | 2403 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+ 2404 | ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating point values. | 2405 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+ 2406 | ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. | 2407 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+ 2408 2409 There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied 2410 by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the 2411 bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that 2412 single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in 2413 LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style 2414 arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for 2415 example. 2416 2417 .. _t_struct: 2418 2419 Structure Type 2420 """""""""""""" 2421 2422 :Overview: 2423 2424 The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members 2425 together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has 2426 a size. 2427 2428 Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by 2429 getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction. 2430 Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and 2431 '``insertvalue``' instructions. 2432 2433 Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that 2434 the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding 2435 between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types 2436 is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is 2437 required to match what the underlying code generator expects. 2438 2439 Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure 2440 is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas 2441 identified types are always defined at the top level with a name. 2442 Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive 2443 or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be 2444 recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued. 2445 2446 :Syntax: 2447 2448 :: 2449 2450 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type 2451 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type 2452 2453 :Examples: 2454 2455 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2456 | ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values | 2457 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2458 | ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. | 2459 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2460 | ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. | 2461 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 2462 2463 .. _t_opaque: 2464 2465 Opaque Structure Types 2466 """""""""""""""""""""" 2467 2468 :Overview: 2469 2470 Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that 2471 do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C 2472 notion of a forward declared structure. 2473 2474 :Syntax: 2475 2476 :: 2477 2478 %X = type opaque 2479 %52 = type opaque 2480 2481 :Examples: 2482 2483 +--------------+-------------------+ 2484 | ``opaque`` | An opaque type. | 2485 +--------------+-------------------+ 2486 2487 .. _constants: 2488 2489 Constants 2490 ========= 2491 2492 LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section 2493 describes them all and their syntax. 2494 2495 Simple Constants 2496 ---------------- 2497 2498 **Boolean constants** 2499 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants 2500 of the ``i1`` type. 2501 **Integer constants** 2502 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the 2503 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with 2504 integer types. 2505 **Floating point constants** 2506 Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g. 2507 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise 2508 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact 2509 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the 2510 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating 2511 decimal in binary. Floating point constants must have a :ref:`floating 2512 point <t_floating>` type. 2513 **Null pointer constants** 2514 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant 2515 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`. 2516 **Token constants** 2517 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant 2518 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`. 2519 2520 The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of 2521 floating point constants. For example, the form 2522 '``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read 2523 than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating point 2524 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the 2525 disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it 2526 cannot be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable 2527 number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special 2528 values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly 2529 and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants. 2530 2531 When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and 2532 double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which 2533 matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values 2534 must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single 2535 precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long 2536 double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used 2537 by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The 2538 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by 2539 ``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is 2540 represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles 2541 will only work if they match the long double format on your target. 2542 The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH`` 2543 followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian 2544 (sign bit at the left). 2545 2546 There are no constants of type x86_mmx. 2547 2548 .. _complexconstants: 2549 2550 Complex Constants 2551 ----------------- 2552 2553 Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple 2554 constants and smaller complex constants. 2555 2556 **Structure constants** 2557 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to 2558 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, 2559 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example: 2560 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as 2561 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have 2562 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements 2563 must match those specified by the type. 2564 **Array constants** 2565 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type 2566 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by 2567 square brackets (``[]``)). For example: 2568 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have 2569 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must 2570 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array 2571 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c`` 2572 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``". 2573 **Vector constants** 2574 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector 2575 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by 2576 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example: 2577 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants 2578 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of 2579 elements must match those specified by the type. 2580 **Zero initialization** 2581 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a 2582 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and 2583 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid 2584 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and 2585 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers. 2586 **Metadata node** 2587 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example: 2588 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values, 2589 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``". 2590 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of 2591 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional 2592 information such as debug info. 2593 2594 Global Variable and Function Addresses 2595 -------------------------------------- 2596 2597 The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and 2598 :ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid 2599 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when 2600 the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have 2601 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM 2602 file: 2603 2604 .. code-block:: llvm 2605 2606 @X = global i32 17 2607 @Y = global i32 42 2608 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ] 2609 2610 .. _undefvalues: 2611 2612 Undefined Values 2613 ---------------- 2614 2615 The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and 2616 indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified 2617 bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``' 2618 or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted. 2619 2620 Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that 2621 the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the 2622 compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of 2623 (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR): 2624 2625 .. code-block:: llvm 2626 2627 %A = add %X, undef 2628 %B = sub %X, undef 2629 %C = xor %X, undef 2630 Safe: 2631 %A = undef 2632 %B = undef 2633 %C = undef 2634 2635 This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef 2636 bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits. 2637 2638 .. code-block:: llvm 2639 2640 %A = or %X, undef 2641 %B = and %X, undef 2642 Safe: 2643 %A = -1 2644 %B = 0 2645 Unsafe: 2646 %A = undef 2647 %B = undef 2648 2649 These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the 2650 input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the 2651 '``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what 2652 the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to 2653 optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'. 2654 However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be 2655 0, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that 2656 all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set, 2657 allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1. 2658 2659 .. code-block:: llvm 2660 2661 %A = select undef, %X, %Y 2662 %B = select undef, 42, %Y 2663 %C = select %X, %Y, undef 2664 Safe: 2665 %A = %X (or %Y) 2666 %B = 42 (or %Y) 2667 %C = %Y 2668 Unsafe: 2669 %A = undef 2670 %B = undef 2671 %C = undef 2672 2673 This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional 2674 branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one 2675 of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were 2676 both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a 2677 cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is 2678 allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as 2679 ``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated. 2680 2681 .. code-block:: llvm 2682 2683 %A = xor undef, undef 2684 2685 %B = undef 2686 %C = xor %B, %B 2687 2688 %D = undef 2689 %E = icmp slt %D, 4 2690 %F = icmp gte %D, 4 2691 2692 Safe: 2693 %A = undef 2694 %B = undef 2695 %C = undef 2696 %D = undef 2697 %E = undef 2698 %F = undef 2699 2700 This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not 2701 necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches 2702 C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if 2703 ``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the 2704 short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change 2705 its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable 2706 doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically 2707 read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so 2708 the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and 2709 ``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all 2710 uses with" concept would not hold. 2711 2712 .. code-block:: llvm 2713 2714 %A = fdiv undef, %X 2715 %B = fdiv %X, undef 2716 Safe: 2717 %A = undef 2718 b: unreachable 2719 2720 These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value* 2721 and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is 2722 allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A`` 2723 operation can be constant folded to '``undef``', because the '``undef``' 2724 could be an SNaN, and ``fdiv`` is not (currently) defined on SNaN's. 2725 However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive 2726 assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value, 2727 we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero 2728 has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation 2729 does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all 2730 code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the 2731 optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code. 2732 2733 .. code-block:: llvm 2734 2735 a: store undef -> %X 2736 b: store %X -> undef 2737 Safe: 2738 a: <deleted> 2739 b: unreachable 2740 2741 These examples reiterate the ``fdiv`` example: a store *of* an undefined 2742 value can be assumed to not have any effect; we can assume that the 2743 value is overwritten with bits that happen to match what was already 2744 there. However, a store *to* an undefined location could clobber 2745 arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined behavior. 2746 2747 .. _poisonvalues: 2748 2749 Poison Values 2750 ------------- 2751 2752 Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however 2753 they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression 2754 that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition 2755 that results in undefined behavior. 2756 2757 There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they 2758 only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with 2759 the ``nsw`` flag. 2760 2761 Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*: 2762 2763 - Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands. 2764 - :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to 2765 their dynamic predecessor basic block. 2766 - Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values 2767 in the dynamic callers of their functions. 2768 - :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>` 2769 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them. 2770 - :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the 2771 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing 2772 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them. 2773 - Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all 2774 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR 2775 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as 2776 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.) 2777 - An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the 2778 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side 2779 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile 2780 operations <volatile>`.) 2781 - An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator 2782 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has 2783 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when 2784 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed 2785 when control is transferred to another. 2786 - Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator 2787 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would 2788 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different 2789 successor. 2790 - Dependence is transitive. 2791 2792 Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, 2793 with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence* 2794 on a poison value has undefined behavior. 2795 2796 Here are some examples: 2797 2798 .. code-block:: llvm 2799 2800 entry: 2801 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value. 2802 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison. 2803 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison 2804 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned 2805 2806 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory. 2807 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory. 2808 2809 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior. 2810 2811 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16* 2812 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64* 2813 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value. 2814 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value. 2815 2816 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value. 2817 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination. 2818 2819 true: 2820 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so 2821 ; it has undefined behavior. 2822 br label %end 2823 2824 end: 2825 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ] 2826 ; Both edges into this PHI are 2827 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this 2828 ; always results in a poison value. 2829 2830 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true 2831 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry 2832 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior. 2833 2834 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end 2835 ; The same branch again, but this time the 2836 ; true block doesn't have side effects. 2837 2838 second_true: 2839 ; No side effects! 2840 ret void 2841 2842 second_end: 2843 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends 2844 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is 2845 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is 2846 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined 2847 ; behavior in this example). 2848 2849 .. _blockaddress: 2850 2851 Addresses of Basic Blocks 2852 ------------------------- 2853 2854 ``blockaddress(@function, %block)`` 2855 2856 The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified 2857 basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type. 2858 Taking the address of the entry block is illegal. 2859 2860 This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the 2861 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons 2862 against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in 2863 undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and 2864 no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an 2865 opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This 2866 allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so 2867 long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr`` 2868 instruction. 2869 2870 Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value 2871 as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific. 2872 2873 .. _constantexprs: 2874 2875 Constant Expressions 2876 -------------------- 2877 2878 Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other 2879 constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any 2880 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation 2881 that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported). 2882 The following is the syntax for constant expressions: 2883 2884 ``trunc (CST to TYPE)`` 2885 Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be 2886 larger than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers. 2887 ``zext (CST to TYPE)`` 2888 Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be 2889 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers. 2890 ``sext (CST to TYPE)`` 2891 Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be 2892 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers. 2893 ``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)`` 2894 Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type. 2895 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types 2896 must be floating point. 2897 ``fpext (CST to TYPE)`` 2898 Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST 2899 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be 2900 floating point. 2901 ``fptoui (CST to TYPE)`` 2902 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned 2903 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST 2904 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE 2905 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the 2906 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined. 2907 ``fptosi (CST to TYPE)`` 2908 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed 2909 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST 2910 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE 2911 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the 2912 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined. 2913 ``uitofp (CST to TYPE)`` 2914 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating 2915 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type. 2916 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must 2917 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value 2918 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined. 2919 ``sitofp (CST to TYPE)`` 2920 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating 2921 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type. 2922 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must 2923 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value 2924 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined. 2925 ``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)`` 2926 Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer 2927 constant. ``TYPE`` must be an integer type. ``CST`` must be of 2928 pointer type. The ``CST`` value is zero extended, truncated, or 2929 unchanged to make it fit in ``TYPE``. 2930 ``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)`` 2931 Convert an integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a 2932 pointer type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero 2933 extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size. 2934 This one is *really* dangerous! 2935 ``bitcast (CST to TYPE)`` 2936 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the 2937 operands are the same as those for the :ref:`bitcast 2938 instruction <i_bitcast>`. 2939 ``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)`` 2940 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another 2941 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the 2942 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`. 2943 ``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)`` 2944 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on 2945 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>` 2946 instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are 2947 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY". 2948 ``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)`` 2949 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants. 2950 ``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)`` 2951 Performs the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants. 2952 ``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)`` 2953 Performs the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants. 2954 ``extractelement (VAL, IDX)`` 2955 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on 2956 constants. 2957 ``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)`` 2958 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on 2959 constants. 2960 ``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)`` 2961 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on 2962 constants. 2963 ``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)`` 2964 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on 2965 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as 2966 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At 2967 least one index value must be specified. 2968 ``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)`` 2969 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants. 2970 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a 2971 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index 2972 value must be specified. 2973 ``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)`` 2974 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE 2975 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise 2976 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are 2977 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise 2978 operations on floating point values are allowed). 2979 2980 Other Values 2981 ============ 2982 2983 .. _inlineasmexprs: 2984 2985 Inline Assembler Expressions 2986 ---------------------------- 2987 2988 LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level 2989 Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value 2990 represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the 2991 instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a 2992 flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects, 2993 and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its 2994 stack conservatively. 2995 2996 The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``" 2997 followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory 2998 location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also 2999 be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the 3000 operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`). 3001 3002 A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include 3003 other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be 3004 used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the 3005 resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is 3006 disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly 3007 syntax known to LLVM. 3008 3009 LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's 3010 GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and 3011 modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm 3012 support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings 3013 described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and, 3014 while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get 3015 translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM 3016 assembly. 3017 3018 An example inline assembler expression is: 3019 3020 .. code-block:: llvm 3021 3022 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r" 3023 3024 Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand 3025 of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction. 3026 Thus, typically we have: 3027 3028 .. code-block:: llvm 3029 3030 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y) 3031 3032 Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be 3033 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the 3034 '``sideeffect``' keyword, like so: 3035 3036 .. code-block:: llvm 3037 3038 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""() 3039 3040 In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless 3041 the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on 3042 x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm. 3043 The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm 3044 might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the 3045 prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present: 3046 3047 .. code-block:: llvm 3048 3049 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""() 3050 3051 Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The 3052 assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present, 3053 the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are 3054 the only supported dialects. An example is: 3055 3056 .. code-block:: llvm 3057 3058 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""() 3059 3060 If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come 3061 first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``' 3062 keyword last. 3063 3064 Inline Asm Constraint String 3065 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 3066 3067 The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or 3068 more constraint codes. 3069 3070 For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory 3071 operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template 3072 string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the 3073 second, etc. 3074 3075 There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a 3076 prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The 3077 constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then 3078 clobbers. They cannot be intermingled. 3079 3080 There are also three different categories of constraint codes: 3081 3082 - Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical 3083 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary, 3084 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type. 3085 - Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction 3086 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing 3087 modes used by the target. 3088 - Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other 3089 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The 3090 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the 3091 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with. 3092 3093 Output constraints 3094 """""""""""""""""" 3095 3096 Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This 3097 indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will 3098 then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output 3099 constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see 3100 below about indirect outputs). 3101 3102 Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly 3103 expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign 3104 the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the 3105 assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and 3106 the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``" 3107 modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an 3108 "early-clobber" output. Marking an ouput as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM 3109 will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this 3110 output). 3111 3112 Input constraints 3113 """"""""""""""""" 3114 3115 Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input 3116 constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not 3117 permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless 3118 that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be 3119 assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all 3120 contain the same value. 3121 3122 Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie" 3123 themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint 3124 string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and 3125 take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply 3126 be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied 3127 to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for 3128 output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th 3129 constraint). 3130 3131 It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no 3132 *other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber 3133 (even when the other input has the same value). 3134 3135 You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a 3136 memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output. 3137 3138 There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a 3139 register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value 3140 type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple 3141 registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm. 3142 3143 However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think. 3144 3145 Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those 3146 architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive 3147 instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit 3148 SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The 3149 hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This 3150 feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.) 3151 3152 A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access 3153 to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and 3154 ``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated 3155 register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still 3156 probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for 3157 clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which, 3158 despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to 3159 use) 3160 3161 Indirect inputs and outputs 3162 """"""""""""""""""""""""""" 3163 3164 Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier 3165 (which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm 3166 will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input 3167 argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than 3168 an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression, 3169 rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an 3170 "output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input 3171 memory location, instead of just read from it). 3172 3173 This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the 3174 address of a variable as a value. 3175 3176 It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output 3177 (e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output 3178 value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as 3179 input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this 3180 functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm 3181 statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many 3182 optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.) 3183 3184 3185 Clobber constraints 3186 """"""""""""""""""" 3187 3188 A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not 3189 consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the 3190 general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register 3191 constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of 3192 "``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared 3193 memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect 3194 output. 3195 3196 3197 Constraint Codes 3198 """""""""""""""" 3199 After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes. 3200 3201 A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character 3202 followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``" 3203 (e.g. "``{eax}``"). 3204 3205 The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as 3206 GCC's constraint codes. 3207 3208 A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving 3209 it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for 3210 compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang. 3211 3212 There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an 3213 inline asm constraint list: 3214 3215 1) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``" 3216 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The 3217 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the 3218 constraint list. 3219 3220 2) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every 3221 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative 3222 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the 3223 constraint list will be chosen together. 3224 3225 Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like 3226 ``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then 3227 operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1 3228 may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m. 3229 3230 However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as 3231 LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the 3232 point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so 3233 in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to 3234 compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll 3235 always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers, 3236 or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it 3237 doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are 3238 unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like 3239 ``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was 3240 intended.) 3241 3242 Supported Constraint Code List 3243 """""""""""""""""""""""""""""" 3244 3245 The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in 3246 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C 3247 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM 3248 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM. 3249 3250 Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets: 3251 3252 - ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class. 3253 - ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes 3254 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset, 3255 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size). 3256 - ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple 3257 immediate, or a relocatable value. 3258 - ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values. 3259 - ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values. 3260 - ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically 3261 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call. 3262 3263 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm 3264 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???) 3265 3266 - ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register. 3267 3268 Other constraints are target-specific: 3269 3270 AArch64: 3271 3272 - ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate. 3273 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction, 3274 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12. 3275 - ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or 3276 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12. 3277 - ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a 3278 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register. 3279 - ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a 3280 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register. 3281 - ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a 3282 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask 3283 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single 3284 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction. 3285 - ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a 3286 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``. 3287 - ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no 3288 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as 3289 well.) 3290 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*). 3291 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register. 3292 - ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``). 3293 3294 AMDGPU: 3295 3296 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register. 3297 - ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9. 3298 - ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9. 3299 3300 3301 All ARM modes: 3302 3303 - ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address 3304 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment. 3305 3306 ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode: 3307 3308 - ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``) 3309 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction. 3310 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095. 3311 - ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a 3312 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to 3313 print the inverted value). 3314 - ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing 3315 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated 3316 value). 3317 - ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32. 3318 - ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint. 3319 - ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint. 3320 - ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``). 3321 - ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same 3322 as ``r``. 3323 - ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode, 3324 invalid. 3325 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, 3326 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``. 3327 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``, 3328 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``. 3329 - ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values: 3330 ``s0-s31``. 3331 3332 ARM's Thumb1 mode: 3333 3334 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255. 3335 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1. 3336 - ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by 3337 some amount. 3338 - ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7. 3339 - ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020. 3340 - ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31. 3341 - ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508. 3342 - ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``). 3343 - ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``). 3344 - ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``). 3345 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, 3346 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``. 3347 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``, 3348 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``. 3349 - ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values: 3350 ``s0-s31``. 3351 3352 3353 Hexagon: 3354 3355 - ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``, 3356 at the moment. 3357 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register. 3358 3359 MSP430: 3360 3361 - ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register. 3362 3363 MIPS: 3364 3365 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer. 3366 - ``J``: An immediate integer zero. 3367 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer. 3368 - ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0. 3369 - ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1. 3370 - ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer. 3371 - ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535. 3372 - ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address 3373 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register. 3374 - ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address 3375 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint 3376 ``m``. 3377 - ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or 3378 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary). 3379 - ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register. 3380 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register 3381 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w`` 3382 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC. 3383 - ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always 3384 ``25``). 3385 - ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit. 3386 - ``x``: Invalid. 3387 3388 NVPTX: 3389 3390 - ``b``: A 1-bit integer register. 3391 - ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register. 3392 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register. 3393 - ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register. 3394 - ``f``: A 32-bit float register. 3395 - ``d``: A 64-bit float register. 3396 3397 3398 PowerPC: 3399 3400 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer. 3401 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits. 3402 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer. 3403 - ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits. 3404 - ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31. 3405 - ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2. 3406 - ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0. 3407 - ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit 3408 constant. 3409 - ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently 3410 treated the same as ``m``. 3411 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register. 3412 - ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is: 3413 ``R1-R31``). 3414 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a 3415 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers). 3416 - ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a 3417 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit 3418 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``). 3419 3420 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this 3421 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers? 3422 3423 - ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``). 3424 - ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register. 3425 - ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX 3426 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files). 3427 - ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating point register, from the full VSX register 3428 set. 3429 3430 Sparc: 3431 3432 - ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer. 3433 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register. 3434 3435 SystemZ: 3436 3437 - ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer. 3438 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer. 3439 - ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer. 3440 - ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer. 3441 - ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff. 3442 - ``Q``, ``R``, ``S``, ``T``: A memory address operand, treated the same as 3443 ``m``, at the moment. 3444 - ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register. 3445 - ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an 3446 address context evaluates as zero). 3447 - ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register 3448 (LLVM-specific) 3449 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating point register. 3450 3451 X86: 3452 3453 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31. 3454 - ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64. 3455 - ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer. 3456 - ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only) 3457 0xffffffff. 3458 - ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3. 3459 - ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer. 3460 - ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127. 3461 - ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer. 3462 - ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer. 3463 - ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment. 3464 - ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit 3465 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` 3466 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers. 3467 - ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit 3468 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers. 3469 - ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register. 3470 - ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has 3471 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix. 3472 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register. 3473 - ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled. 3474 - ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector 3475 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit 3476 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a 3477 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error. 3478 - ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error. 3479 - ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in 3480 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It 3481 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit 3482 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed, 3483 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm 3484 statement. 3485 3486 XCore: 3487 3488 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register. 3489 3490 3491 .. _inline-asm-modifiers: 3492 3493 Asm template argument modifiers 3494 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 3495 3496 In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like 3497 "``${0:n}``". 3498 3499 The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in 3500 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C 3501 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM 3502 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM. 3503 3504 Target-independent: 3505 3506 - ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without 3507 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix). 3508 - ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the 3509 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix). 3510 - ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label 3511 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix). 3512 3513 AArch64: 3514 3515 - ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g., 3516 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``. 3517 - ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow). 3518 - ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a 3519 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of 3520 ``v*``. 3521 3522 AMDGPU: 3523 3524 - ``r``: No effect. 3525 3526 ARM: 3527 3528 - ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a 3529 register). 3530 - ``P``: No effect. 3531 - ``q``: No effect. 3532 - ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print 3533 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``) 3534 - ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#`` 3535 prefix. 3536 - ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant. 3537 - ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all* 3538 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully. 3539 - ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order 3540 register of a two-register operand. 3541 - ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order 3542 register of a two-register operand. 3543 - ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system, 3544 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent 3545 to ``R``.) 3546 3547 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register 3548 of a two-register operand. 3549 3550 - ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register. 3551 - ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register. 3552 - ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]`` 3553 adornment. 3554 3555 Hexagon: 3556 3557 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it 3558 has been allocated consecutively to the first. 3559 3560 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's 3561 nothing that ensures that happens, is there? 3562 3563 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise 3564 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions. 3565 3566 MSP430: 3567 3568 No additional modifiers. 3569 3570 MIPS: 3571 3572 - ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal 3573 - ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal. 3574 - ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal. 3575 - ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal. 3576 - ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally. 3577 - ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the 3578 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand. 3579 3580 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support. 3581 3582 - ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the 3583 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand. 3584 3585 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support. 3586 3587 - ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the 3588 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is 3589 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to 3590 ``M``.) 3591 - ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this 3592 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f`` 3593 constraint. 3594 3595 NVPTX: 3596 3597 - ``r``: No effect. 3598 3599 PowerPC: 3600 3601 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it 3602 has been allocated consecutively to the first. 3603 3604 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's 3605 nothing that ensures that happens, is there? 3606 3607 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise 3608 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions. 3609 - ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form 3610 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``). 3611 - ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing 3612 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently 3613 always print nothing) 3614 - ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does 3615 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing) 3616 3617 Sparc: 3618 3619 - ``r``: No effect. 3620 3621 SystemZ: 3622 3623 SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other 3624 target-independent modifiers. 3625 3626 X86: 3627 3628 - ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is 3629 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier). 3630 - ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it. 3631 - ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory 3632 operand. 3633 - ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a 3634 memory operand. 3635 - ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory 3636 operand. 3637 - ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory 3638 operand. 3639 - ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are 3640 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand. 3641 - ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an 3642 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before 3643 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a 3644 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier) 3645 - ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8. 3646 - ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call 3647 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.) 3648 3649 XCore: 3650 3651 No additional modifiers. 3652 3653 3654 Inline Asm Metadata 3655 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 3656 3657 The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a 3658 "``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant 3659 integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the 3660 location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext`` 3661 error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend 3662 errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced 3663 it. For example: 3664 3665 .. code-block:: llvm 3666 3667 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42 3668 ... 3669 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 } 3670 3671 It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places 3672 in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator 3673 will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error 3674 occurs on. 3675 3676 .. _metadata: 3677 3678 Metadata 3679 ======== 3680 3681 LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program 3682 that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and 3683 code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level 3684 debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes. 3685 3686 Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a 3687 ``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type. 3688 3689 All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``'). 3690 3691 .. _metadata-string: 3692 3693 Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings 3694 ----------------------------------- 3695 3696 A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can 3697 contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with 3698 "``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example: 3699 "``!"test\00"``". 3700 3701 Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure 3702 constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and 3703 preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as 3704 their operand. For example: 3705 3706 .. code-block:: llvm 3707 3708 !{ !"test\00", i32 10} 3709 3710 Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example: 3711 3712 .. code-block:: llvm 3713 3714 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10} 3715 3716 ``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their 3717 content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions 3718 when metadata operands change. 3719 3720 A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of 3721 metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For 3722 example: 3723 3724 .. code-block:: llvm 3725 3726 !foo = !{!4, !3} 3727 3728 Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here ``llvm.dbg.value`` 3729 function is using two metadata arguments: 3730 3731 .. code-block:: llvm 3732 3733 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, i64 0, metadata !25) 3734 3735 Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached 3736 to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier: 3737 3738 .. code-block:: llvm 3739 3740 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21 3741 3742 Metadata can also be attached to a function definition. Here metadata ``!22`` 3743 is attached to the ``foo`` function using the ``!dbg`` identifier: 3744 3745 .. code-block:: llvm 3746 3747 define void @foo() !dbg !22 { 3748 ret void 3749 } 3750 3751 More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the 3752 optimizers and code generator is found below. 3753 3754 .. _specialized-metadata: 3755 3756 Specialized Metadata Nodes 3757 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 3758 3759 Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed 3760 to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any 3761 order. 3762 3763 These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized 3764 metadata nodes are related to debug info. 3765 3766 .. _DICompileUnit: 3767 3768 DICompileUnit 3769 """"""""""""" 3770 3771 ``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``, 3772 ``retainedTypes:``, ``subprograms:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:`` 3773 fields are tuples containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile 3774 unit, regardless of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are 3775 references to them from instructions). 3776 3777 .. code-block:: llvm 3778 3779 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang", 3780 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2, 3781 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: 1, 3782 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, subprograms: !4, 3783 globals: !5, imports: !6, macros: !7, dwoId: 0x0abcd) 3784 3785 Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a 3786 specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope. 3787 These descriptors are collected by a named metadata ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They 3788 keep track of subprograms, global variables, type information, and imported 3789 entities (declarations and namespaces). 3790 3791 .. _DIFile: 3792 3793 DIFile 3794 """""" 3795 3796 ``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes. 3797 3798 .. code-block:: llvm 3799 3800 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir") 3801 3802 Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target 3803 for ``file:`` fields. 3804 3805 .. _DIBasicType: 3806 3807 DIBasicType 3808 """"""""""" 3809 3810 ``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and 3811 ``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``. 3812 3813 .. code-block:: llvm 3814 3815 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8, 3816 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char) 3817 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)") 3818 3819 The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the 3820 following: 3821 3822 .. code-block:: llvm 3823 3824 DW_ATE_address = 1 3825 DW_ATE_boolean = 2 3826 DW_ATE_float = 4 3827 DW_ATE_signed = 5 3828 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6 3829 DW_ATE_unsigned = 7 3830 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8 3831 3832 .. _DISubroutineType: 3833 3834 DISubroutineType 3835 """""""""""""""" 3836 3837 ``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field 3838 refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the 3839 types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that 3840 represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++). 3841 3842 .. code-block:: llvm 3843 3844 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed) 3845 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char) 3846 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char) 3847 3848 .. _DIDerivedType: 3849 3850 DIDerivedType 3851 """"""""""""" 3852 3853 ``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as 3854 qualified types. 3855 3856 .. code-block:: llvm 3857 3858 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8, 3859 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char) 3860 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32, 3861 align: 32) 3862 3863 The following ``tag:`` values are valid: 3864 3865 .. code-block:: llvm 3866 3867 DW_TAG_formal_parameter = 5 3868 DW_TAG_member = 13 3869 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15 3870 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16 3871 DW_TAG_typedef = 22 3872 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31 3873 DW_TAG_const_type = 38 3874 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53 3875 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55 3876 3877 ``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type 3878 <DICompositeType>` or :ref:`subprogram <DISubprogram>`. The type of the member 3879 is the ``baseType:``. The ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. 3880 ``DW_TAG_formal_parameter`` is used to define a member which is a formal 3881 argument of a subprogram. 3882 3883 ``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``. 3884 3885 ``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``, 3886 ``DW_TAG_volatile_type`` and ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` are used to qualify the 3887 ``baseType:``. 3888 3889 Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL. 3890 3891 .. _DICompositeType: 3892 3893 DICompositeType 3894 """"""""""""""" 3895 3896 ``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like 3897 structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types. 3898 3899 If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique 3900 identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified, other types 3901 can refer to composite types indirectly via a :ref:`metadata string 3902 <metadata-string>` that matches their identifier. 3903 3904 .. code-block:: llvm 3905 3906 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7) 3907 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7) 3908 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8) 3909 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12, 3910 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum", 3911 elements: !{!0, !1, !2}) 3912 3913 The following ``tag:`` values are valid: 3914 3915 .. code-block:: llvm 3916 3917 DW_TAG_array_type = 1 3918 DW_TAG_class_type = 2 3919 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4 3920 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19 3921 DW_TAG_union_type = 23 3922 DW_TAG_subroutine_type = 21 3923 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28 3924 3925 3926 For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange 3927 descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that 3928 level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an 3929 array type is a native packed vector. 3930 3931 For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator 3932 descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration 3933 value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the 3934 ``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`. 3935 3936 For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and 3937 ``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types 3938 <DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member`` or ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``. 3939 3940 .. _DISubrange: 3941 3942 DISubrange 3943 """""""""" 3944 3945 ``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of 3946 :ref:`DICompositeType`. ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array. 3947 3948 .. code-block:: llvm 3949 3950 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0 3951 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1 3952 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array. 3953 3954 .. _DIEnumerator: 3955 3956 DIEnumerator 3957 """""""""""" 3958 3959 ``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type`` 3960 variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`. 3961 3962 .. code-block:: llvm 3963 3964 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7) 3965 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7) 3966 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8) 3967 3968 DITemplateTypeParameter 3969 """"""""""""""""""""""" 3970 3971 ``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source 3972 language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and 3973 :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields. 3974 3975 .. code-block:: llvm 3976 3977 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1) 3978 3979 DITemplateValueParameter 3980 """""""""""""""""""""""" 3981 3982 ``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source 3983 language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``, 3984 but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or 3985 ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in 3986 :ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields. 3987 3988 .. code-block:: llvm 3989 3990 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7) 3991 3992 DINamespace 3993 """"""""""" 3994 3995 ``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language. 3996 3997 .. code-block:: llvm 3998 3999 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7) 4000 4001 DIGlobalVariable 4002 """""""""""""""" 4003 4004 ``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language. 4005 4006 .. code-block:: llvm 4007 4008 !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1, 4009 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true, 4010 isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo, 4011 declaration: !4) 4012 4013 All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a 4014 :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`. 4015 4016 .. _DISubprogram: 4017 4018 DISubprogram 4019 """""""""""" 4020 4021 ``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A 4022 ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg`` 4023 metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>` 4024 that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of 4025 the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`. 4026 4027 .. code-block:: llvm 4028 4029 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 { 4030 ... 4031 } 4032 4033 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1, 4034 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true, 4035 isDefinition: false, scopeLine: 8, 4036 containingType: !4, 4037 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual, 4038 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped, 4039 isOptimized: true, templateParams: !5, 4040 declaration: !6, variables: !7) 4041 4042 .. _DILexicalBlock: 4043 4044 DILexicalBlock 4045 """""""""""""" 4046 4047 ``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram 4048 <DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish 4049 two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:`` 4050 fields. 4051 4052 .. code-block:: llvm 4053 4054 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35) 4055 4056 Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on 4057 operands. 4058 4059 .. _DILexicalBlockFile: 4060 4061 DILexicalBlockFile 4062 """""""""""""""""" 4063 4064 ``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a 4065 :ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to 4066 indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to 4067 discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language. 4068 4069 .. code-block:: llvm 4070 4071 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35) 4072 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0) 4073 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1) 4074 4075 .. _DILocation: 4076 4077 DILocation 4078 """""""""" 4079 4080 ``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is 4081 mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an 4082 :ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`. 4083 4084 .. code-block:: llvm 4085 4086 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2) 4087 4088 .. _DILocalVariable: 4089 4090 DILocalVariable 4091 """"""""""""""" 4092 4093 ``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If 4094 the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram 4095 parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its 4096 :ref:`DISubprogram`. 4097 4098 .. code-block:: llvm 4099 4100 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7, 4101 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial) 4102 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7, 4103 type: !3) 4104 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3) 4105 4106 DIExpression 4107 """""""""""" 4108 4109 ``DIExpression`` nodes represent DWARF expression sequences. They are used in 4110 :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>` (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare``) to 4111 describe how the referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language 4112 variable. 4113 4114 The current supported vocabulary is limited: 4115 4116 - ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the working expression. 4117 - ``DW_OP_plus, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression. 4118 - ``DW_OP_bit_piece, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8`` 4119 here, respectively) of the variable piece from the working expression. 4120 4121 .. code-block:: llvm 4122 4123 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref) 4124 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus, 3) 4125 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7) 4126 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_plus, 3, DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7) 4127 4128 DIObjCProperty 4129 """""""""""""" 4130 4131 ``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes. 4132 4133 .. code-block:: llvm 4134 4135 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo", 4136 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2) 4137 4138 DIImportedEntity 4139 """""""""""""""" 4140 4141 ``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a 4142 compile unit. 4143 4144 .. code-block:: llvm 4145 4146 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0, 4147 entity: !1, line: 7) 4148 4149 DIMacro 4150 """"""" 4151 4152 ``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers. 4153 The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when 4154 definining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string 4155 used to expand the macro identifier. 4156 4157 .. code-block:: llvm 4158 4159 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)", 4160 value: "((x) + 1)") 4161 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo") 4162 4163 DIMacroFile 4164 """"""""""" 4165 4166 ``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files. 4167 The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that 4168 appear in the included source file. 4169 4170 .. code-block:: llvm 4171 4172 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2, 4173 nodes: !3) 4174 4175 '``tbaa``' Metadata 4176 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4177 4178 In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not 4179 suitable for doing TBAA. Instead, metadata is added to the IR to 4180 describe a type system of a higher level language. This can be used to 4181 implement typical C/C++ TBAA, but it can also be used to implement 4182 custom alias analysis behavior for other languages. 4183 4184 The current metadata format is very simple. TBAA metadata nodes have up 4185 to three fields, e.g.: 4186 4187 .. code-block:: llvm 4188 4189 !0 = !{ !"an example type tree" } 4190 !1 = !{ !"int", !0 } 4191 !2 = !{ !"float", !0 } 4192 !3 = !{ !"const float", !2, i64 1 } 4193 4194 The first field is an identity field. It can be any value, usually a 4195 metadata string, which uniquely identifies the type. The most important 4196 name in the tree is the name of the root node. Two trees with different 4197 root node names are entirely disjoint, even if they have leaves with 4198 common names. 4199 4200 The second field identifies the type's parent node in the tree, or is 4201 null or omitted for a root node. A type is considered to alias all of 4202 its descendants and all of its ancestors in the tree. Also, a type is 4203 considered to alias all types in other trees, so that bitcode produced 4204 from multiple front-ends is handled conservatively. 4205 4206 If the third field is present, it's an integer which if equal to 1 4207 indicates that the type is "constant" (meaning 4208 ``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful 4209 AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_). 4210 4211 '``tbaa.struct``' Metadata 4212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4213 4214 The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement 4215 aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it 4216 is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than 4217 strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to 4218 padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields 4219 of the aggregate. 4220 4221 ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a 4222 memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are. 4223 4224 The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata 4225 nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three. 4226 For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a 4227 field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives 4228 its tbaa tag. e.g.: 4229 4230 .. code-block:: llvm 4231 4232 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 } 4233 4234 This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes 4235 with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes 4236 and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2. 4237 4238 Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a 4239 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which 4240 does not carry useful data and need not be preserved. 4241 4242 '``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata 4243 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4244 4245 ``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic 4246 noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access 4247 instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry 4248 ``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other 4249 collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata. 4250 Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and 4251 a domain. When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set 4252 of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a 4253 subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another 4254 instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to 4255 alias. 4256 4257 The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two 4258 entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a 4259 string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A 4260 self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A 4261 descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry. 4262 4263 The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or 4264 three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name 4265 is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A 4266 self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata 4267 reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may 4268 optionally be provided as a third list entry. 4269 4270 For example, 4271 4272 .. code-block:: llvm 4273 4274 ; Two scope domains: 4275 !0 = !{!0} 4276 !1 = !{!1} 4277 4278 ; Some scopes in these domains: 4279 !2 = !{!2, !0} 4280 !3 = !{!3, !0} 4281 !4 = !{!4, !1} 4282 4283 ; Some scope lists: 4284 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4 4285 !6 = !{!4, !3, !2} 4286 !7 = !{!3} 4287 4288 ; These two instructions don't alias: 4289 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5 4290 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5 4291 4292 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes 4293 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list): 4294 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5 4295 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6 4296 4297 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in 4298 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the 4299 ; !alias.scope list): 4300 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6 4301 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7 4302 4303 '``fpmath``' Metadata 4304 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4305 4306 ``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating point 4307 type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the 4308 result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the 4309 compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing 4310 it. ULP is defined as follows: 4311 4312 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive 4313 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one 4314 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the 4315 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers 4316 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``. 4317 4318 The metadata node shall consist of a single positive floating point 4319 number representing the maximum relative error, for example: 4320 4321 .. code-block:: llvm 4322 4323 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs 4324 4325 .. _range-metadata: 4326 4327 '``range``' Metadata 4328 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4329 4330 ``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of 4331 integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value 4332 returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are 4333 represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value 4334 returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive 4335 pair. Each pair has the following properties: 4336 4337 - The type must match the type loaded by the instruction. 4338 - The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``. 4339 - Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants. 4340 - The range is allowed to wrap. 4341 - The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is, 4342 ``a!=b``. 4343 4344 In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and 4345 they must be non-contiguous. 4346 4347 Examples: 4348 4349 .. code-block:: llvm 4350 4351 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1 4352 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1 4353 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5 4354 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont 4355 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5 4356 ... 4357 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 } 4358 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 } 4359 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 } 4360 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 } 4361 4362 '``unpredictable``' Metadata 4363 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4364 4365 ``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch 4366 instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control 4367 flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter 4368 optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata 4369 is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch 4370 or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable. 4371 4372 '``llvm.loop``' 4373 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4374 4375 It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently, 4376 loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction 4377 in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is 4378 guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is 4379 specified with the name ``llvm.loop``. 4380 4381 The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to 4382 itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g., 4383 during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer 4384 to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions. 4385 The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop 4386 constructs: 4387 4388 .. code-block:: llvm 4389 4390 !0 = !{!0} 4391 !1 = !{!1} 4392 4393 The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional 4394 per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated 4395 as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` 4396 suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller: 4397 4398 .. code-block:: llvm 4399 4400 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0 4401 ... 4402 !0 = !{!0, !1} 4403 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4} 4404 4405 '``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``' 4406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4407 4408 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are 4409 used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as 4410 vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in 4411 conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The 4412 ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only 4413 optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if 4414 it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata 4415 which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful 4416 in determining the safety of these transformations. 4417 4418 '``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata 4419 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4420 4421 This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver. 4422 The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the 4423 second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For 4424 example: 4425 4426 .. code-block:: llvm 4427 4428 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4} 4429 4430 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving 4431 multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0 4432 then the interleave count will be determined automatically. 4433 4434 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata 4435 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4436 4437 This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The 4438 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand 4439 is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of 4440 0 disables vectorization: 4441 4442 .. code-block:: llvm 4443 4444 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0} 4445 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1} 4446 4447 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata 4448 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4449 4450 This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first 4451 operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second 4452 operand is an integer specifying the width. For example: 4453 4454 .. code-block:: llvm 4455 4456 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4} 4457 4458 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables 4459 vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to 4460 0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be 4461 determined automatically. 4462 4463 '``llvm.loop.unroll``' 4464 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4465 4466 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling 4467 optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll`` 4468 metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop 4469 identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only 4470 optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the 4471 optimizer believes it is safe to do so. 4472 4473 '``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata 4474 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4475 4476 This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The 4477 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second 4478 operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For 4479 example: 4480 4481 .. code-block:: llvm 4482 4483 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4} 4484 4485 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop 4486 will be partially unrolled. 4487 4488 '``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata 4489 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4490 4491 This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand 4492 which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example: 4493 4494 .. code-block:: llvm 4495 4496 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"} 4497 4498 '``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata 4499 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4500 4501 This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single 4502 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example: 4503 4504 .. code-block:: llvm 4505 4506 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"} 4507 4508 '``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata 4509 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4510 4511 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count 4512 is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known 4513 at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string 4514 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example: 4515 4516 .. code-block:: llvm 4517 4518 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"} 4519 4520 '``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata 4521 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4522 4523 This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The 4524 metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``. 4525 For example: 4526 4527 .. code-block:: llvm 4528 4529 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"} 4530 4531 '``llvm.mem``' 4532 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4533 4534 Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful 4535 for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``. 4536 4537 '``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata 4538 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4539 4540 The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier, 4541 or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops. 4542 The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that 4543 no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted 4544 with the same loop identifier. 4545 4546 Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the 4547 ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the 4548 set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop 4549 carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and 4550 ``L2``. 4551 4552 As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have 4553 ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the 4554 loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel 4555 loop. 4556 4557 Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to 4558 the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional 4559 memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail 4560 safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered 4561 sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics 4562 insert new memory instructions into the loop body). 4563 4564 Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of 4565 both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` 4566 metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata. 4567 4568 .. code-block:: llvm 4569 4570 for.body: 4571 ... 4572 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0 4573 ... 4574 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0 4575 ... 4576 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0 4577 4578 for.end: 4579 ... 4580 !0 = !{!0} 4581 4582 It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the 4583 memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of 4584 the loop identifier metadata node directly: 4585 4586 .. code-block:: llvm 4587 4588 outer.for.body: 4589 ... 4590 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2 4591 ... 4592 br label %inner.for.body 4593 4594 inner.for.body: 4595 ... 4596 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0 4597 ... 4598 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0 4599 ... 4600 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1 4601 4602 inner.for.end: 4603 ... 4604 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2 4605 ... 4606 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2 4607 4608 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body 4609 ... 4610 !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers 4611 !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop 4612 !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop 4613 4614 '``llvm.bitsets``' 4615 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4616 4617 The ``llvm.bitsets`` global metadata is used to implement 4618 :doc:`bitsets <BitSets>`. 4619 4620 '``invariant.group``' Metadata 4621 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 4622 4623 The ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to ``load``/``store`` instructions. 4624 The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells 4625 the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand 4626 within the same invariant group can be assumed to load or store the same 4627 value (but see the ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` intrinsic which affects 4628 when two pointers are considered the same). 4629 4630 Examples: 4631 4632 .. code-block:: llvm 4633 4634 @unknownPtr = external global i8 4635 ... 4636 %ptr = alloca i8 4637 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 4638 call void @foo(i8* %ptr) 4639 4640 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change 4641 call void @foo(i8* %ptr) 4642 %b = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !1 ; Can't assume anything, because group changed 4643 4644 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr) 4645 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr 4646 4647 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr 4648 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42 4649 4650 call void @foo(i8* %ptr) 4651 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* %ptr) 4652 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through invariant.group.barrier to get value of %ptr 4653 4654 ... 4655 declare void @foo(i8*) 4656 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*) 4657 declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8*) 4658 4659 !0 = !{!"magic ptr"} 4660 !1 = !{!"other ptr"} 4661 4662 4663 4664 Module Flags Metadata 4665 ===================== 4666 4667 Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's 4668 subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information. 4669 The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate 4670 this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a 4671 dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to 4672 look it up. 4673 4674 The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets. 4675 Each triplet has the following form: 4676 4677 - The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior 4678 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two 4679 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are 4680 described below. 4681 - The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the 4682 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not 4683 including entries with the **Require** behavior). 4684 - The third element is the value of the flag. 4685 4686 When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting 4687 ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for 4688 each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged 4689 modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will 4690 be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception 4691 is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved. 4692 4693 The following behaviors are supported: 4694 4695 .. list-table:: 4696 :header-rows: 1 4697 :widths: 10 90 4698 4699 * - Value 4700 - Behavior 4701 4702 * - 1 4703 - **Error** 4704 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value 4705 is that of the operands. 4706 4707 * - 2 4708 - **Warning** 4709 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the 4710 operand for the flag from the first module being linked. 4711 4712 * - 3 4713 - **Require** 4714 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a 4715 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a 4716 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the 4717 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is 4718 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can 4719 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an 4720 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior. 4721 4722 * - 4 4723 - **Override** 4724 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the 4725 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values 4726 differ, an error will be emitted. 4727 4728 * - 5 4729 - **Append** 4730 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes. 4731 4732 * - 6 4733 - **AppendUnique** 4734 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata 4735 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped 4736 during the append operation. 4737 4738 It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors, 4739 except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata 4740 value) or **Override**. 4741 4742 An example of module flags: 4743 4744 .. code-block:: llvm 4745 4746 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 } 4747 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 } 4748 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 } 4749 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux", 4750 !{ 4751 !"foo", i32 1 4752 } 4753 } 4754 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 } 4755 4756 - Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior 4757 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their 4758 values are not equal. 4759 4760 - Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The 4761 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value 4762 '37'. 4763 4764 - Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The 4765 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a 4766 warning if their values are not equal. 4767 4768 - Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value: 4769 4770 :: 4771 4772 !{ !"foo", i32 1 } 4773 4774 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not 4775 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is 4776 performed. 4777 4778 Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata 4779 ---------------------------------------------------- 4780 4781 On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage 4782 collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata 4783 consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of 4784 garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more 4785 modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to 4786 be merged rather than appended together. 4787 4788 The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the 4789 following key-value pairs: 4790 4791 .. list-table:: 4792 :header-rows: 1 4793 :widths: 30 70 4794 4795 * - Key 4796 - Value 4797 4798 * - ``Objective-C Version`` 4799 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2. 4800 4801 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version`` 4802 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently 4803 always 0. 4804 4805 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section`` 4806 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are 4807 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and 4808 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for 4809 Objective-C ABI version 2. 4810 4811 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` 4812 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or 4813 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage 4814 collection supported. 4815 4816 * - ``Objective-C GC Only`` 4817 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported. 4818 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the 4819 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2. 4820 4821 Some important flag interactions: 4822 4823 - If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is 4824 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 4825 2, then the resulting module has the 4826 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0. 4827 - A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be 4828 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6. 4829 4830 Automatic Linker Flags Module Flags Metadata 4831 -------------------------------------------- 4832 4833 Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object 4834 files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which 4835 allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have 4836 these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files. 4837 4838 These flags are encoded in the IR using metadata in the module flags section, 4839 using the ``Linker Options`` key. The merge behavior for this flag is required 4840 to be ``AppendUnique``, and the value for the key is expected to be a metadata 4841 node which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a 4842 list of metadata strings defining linker options. 4843 4844 For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of 4845 linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa`` 4846 framework:: 4847 4848 !0 = !{ i32 6, !"Linker Options", 4849 !{ 4850 !{ !"-lz" }, 4851 !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } } 4852 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0 } 4853 4854 The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed 4855 list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option 4856 strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be 4857 preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific 4858 assembly writer or object file emitter. 4859 4860 Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's 4861 linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or 4862 object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR. 4863 4864 C type width Module Flags Metadata 4865 ---------------------------------- 4866 4867 The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the 4868 options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent 4869 linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some 4870 of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum 4871 width. 4872 4873 To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module 4874 flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs: 4875 4876 .. list-table:: 4877 :header-rows: 1 4878 :widths: 30 70 4879 4880 * - Key 4881 - Value 4882 4883 * - short_wchar 4884 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4 4885 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2 4886 4887 * - short_enum 4888 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``. 4889 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can 4890 represent all of its values. 4891 4892 For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was 4893 compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an 4894 enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values:: 4895 4896 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1} 4897 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1} 4898 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0} 4899 4900 .. _intrinsicglobalvariables: 4901 4902 Intrinsic Global Variables 4903 ========================== 4904 4905 LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that 4906 affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here. 4907 All globals of this sort should have a section specified as 4908 "``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with 4909 "``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM. 4910 4911 .. _gv_llvmused: 4912 4913 The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable 4914 ----------------------------------- 4915 4916 The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has 4917 :ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of 4918 pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally 4919 have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal 4920 use of it is: 4921 4922 .. code-block:: llvm 4923 4924 @X = global i8 4 4925 @Y = global i32 123 4926 4927 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [ 4928 i8* @X, 4929 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*) 4930 ], section "llvm.metadata" 4931 4932 If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler, 4933 and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the 4934 symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if 4935 a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the 4936 ``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent 4937 references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and 4938 corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C. 4939 4940 On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the 4941 assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from 4942 molesting the symbol. 4943 4944 .. _gv_llvmcompilerused: 4945 4946 The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable 4947 -------------------------------------------- 4948 4949 The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used`` 4950 directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the 4951 symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to 4952 optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be 4953 by ``@llvm.used``. 4954 4955 This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances, 4956 and should not be exposed to source languages. 4957 4958 .. _gv_llvmglobalctors: 4959 4960 The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable 4961 ------------------------------------------- 4962 4963 .. code-block:: llvm 4964 4965 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* } 4966 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }] 4967 4968 The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor 4969 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function. 4970 The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order 4971 of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of 4972 functions with the same priority is not defined. 4973 4974 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable 4975 or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated 4976 data from the current module is not discarded. 4977 4978 .. _llvmglobaldtors: 4979 4980 The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable 4981 ------------------------------------------- 4982 4983 .. code-block:: llvm 4984 4985 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* } 4986 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }] 4987 4988 The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor 4989 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function. 4990 The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending 4991 order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The 4992 order of functions with the same priority is not defined. 4993 4994 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable 4995 or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated 4996 data from the current module is not discarded. 4997 4998 Instruction Reference 4999 ===================== 5000 5001 The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications 5002 of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary 5003 instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary 5004 instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and 5005 :ref:`other instructions <otherops>`. 5006 5007 .. _terminators: 5008 5009 Terminator Instructions 5010 ----------------------- 5011 5012 As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a 5013 program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which 5014 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These 5015 terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce 5016 control flow, not values (the one exception being the 5017 ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction). 5018 5019 The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`', 5020 ':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`', 5021 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`', 5022 ':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`', 5023 ':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`', 5024 ':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`', 5025 and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'. 5026 5027 .. _i_ret: 5028 5029 '``ret``' Instruction 5030 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5031 5032 Syntax: 5033 """"""" 5034 5035 :: 5036 5037 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function 5038 ret void ; Return from void function 5039 5040 Overview: 5041 """"""""" 5042 5043 The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally 5044 a value) from a function back to the caller. 5045 5046 There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a 5047 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control 5048 flow to occur. 5049 5050 Arguments: 5051 """""""""" 5052 5053 The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the 5054 return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first 5055 class <t_firstclass>`' type. 5056 5057 A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void 5058 return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or 5059 a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a 5060 void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return 5061 value. 5062 5063 Semantics: 5064 """""""""" 5065 5066 When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to 5067 the calling function's context. If the caller is a 5068 ":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the 5069 instruction after the call. If the caller was an 5070 ":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the 5071 beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns 5072 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return 5073 value. 5074 5075 Example: 5076 """""""" 5077 5078 .. code-block:: llvm 5079 5080 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5 5081 ret void ; Return from a void function 5082 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2 5083 5084 .. _i_br: 5085 5086 '``br``' Instruction 5087 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5088 5089 Syntax: 5090 """"""" 5091 5092 :: 5093 5094 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse> 5095 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch 5096 5097 Overview: 5098 """"""""" 5099 5100 The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a 5101 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of 5102 this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an 5103 unconditional branch. 5104 5105 Arguments: 5106 """""""""" 5107 5108 The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single 5109 '``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the 5110 '``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target. 5111 5112 Semantics: 5113 """""""""" 5114 5115 Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``' 5116 argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the 5117 '``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows 5118 to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument. 5119 5120 Example: 5121 """""""" 5122 5123 .. code-block:: llvm 5124 5125 Test: 5126 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b 5127 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal 5128 IfEqual: 5129 ret i32 1 5130 IfUnequal: 5131 ret i32 0 5132 5133 .. _i_switch: 5134 5135 '``switch``' Instruction 5136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5137 5138 Syntax: 5139 """"""" 5140 5141 :: 5142 5143 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ] 5144 5145 Overview: 5146 """"""""" 5147 5148 The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of 5149 several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``' 5150 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible 5151 destinations. 5152 5153 Arguments: 5154 """""""""" 5155 5156 The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer 5157 comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an 5158 array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table 5159 is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries. 5160 5161 Semantics: 5162 """""""""" 5163 5164 The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations. 5165 When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched 5166 for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred 5167 to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred 5168 to the default destination. 5169 5170 Implementation: 5171 """"""""""""""" 5172 5173 Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular 5174 ``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in 5175 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of 5176 chained conditional branches or with a lookup table. 5177 5178 Example: 5179 """""""" 5180 5181 .. code-block:: llvm 5182 5183 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction 5184 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32 5185 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ] 5186 5187 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction 5188 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ] 5189 5190 ; Implement a jump table: 5191 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero 5192 i32 1, label %onone 5193 i32 2, label %ontwo ] 5194 5195 .. _i_indirectbr: 5196 5197 '``indirectbr``' Instruction 5198 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5199 5200 Syntax: 5201 """"""" 5202 5203 :: 5204 5205 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ] 5206 5207 Overview: 5208 """"""""" 5209 5210 The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a 5211 label within the current function, whose address is specified by 5212 "``address``". Address must be derived from a 5213 :ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant. 5214 5215 Arguments: 5216 """""""""" 5217 5218 The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The 5219 rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations 5220 that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple 5221 times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful. 5222 5223 This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an 5224 accurate understanding of the CFG. 5225 5226 Semantics: 5227 """""""""" 5228 5229 Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All 5230 possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise 5231 this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to 5232 labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well. 5233 5234 Implementation: 5235 """"""""""""""" 5236 5237 This is typically implemented with a jump through a register. 5238 5239 Example: 5240 """""""" 5241 5242 .. code-block:: llvm 5243 5244 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ] 5245 5246 .. _i_invoke: 5247 5248 '``invoke``' Instruction 5249 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5250 5251 Syntax: 5252 """"""" 5253 5254 :: 5255 5256 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ptr to function ty> <function ptr val>(<function args>) [fn attrs] 5257 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label> 5258 5259 Overview: 5260 """"""""" 5261 5262 The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified 5263 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the 5264 '``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function 5265 returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the 5266 "normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the 5267 ":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling 5268 mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically 5269 nearest "exception" label. 5270 5271 The '``exception``' label is a `landing 5272 pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such, 5273 '``exception``' label is required to have the 5274 ":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the 5275 information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens, 5276 as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the 5277 "``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``" 5278 instruction, so that the important information contained within the 5279 "``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion. 5280 5281 Arguments: 5282 """""""""" 5283 5284 This instruction requires several arguments: 5285 5286 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling 5287 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is 5288 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. 5289 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return 5290 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes 5291 are valid here. 5292 #. '``ptr to function ty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to 5293 function value being invoked. In most cases, this is a direct 5294 function invocation, but indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, 5295 branching off an arbitrary pointer to function value. 5296 #. '``function ptr val``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a 5297 function to be invoked. 5298 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function 5299 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must 5300 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature 5301 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the 5302 extra arguments can be specified. 5303 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function 5304 executes a '``ret``' instruction. 5305 #. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via 5306 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling 5307 mechanism. 5308 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only 5309 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``' 5310 attributes are valid here. 5311 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list. 5312 5313 Semantics: 5314 """""""""" 5315 5316 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``' 5317 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it 5318 establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime 5319 library to unwind the stack. 5320 5321 This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that 5322 proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a 5323 thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of 5324 '``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them. 5325 5326 For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned 5327 by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the 5328 current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no 5329 return value is available. 5330 5331 Example: 5332 """""""" 5333 5334 .. code-block:: llvm 5335 5336 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue 5337 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set 5338 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue 5339 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set 5340 5341 .. _i_resume: 5342 5343 '``resume``' Instruction 5344 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5345 5346 Syntax: 5347 """"""" 5348 5349 :: 5350 5351 resume <type> <value> 5352 5353 Overview: 5354 """"""""" 5355 5356 The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no 5357 successors. 5358 5359 Arguments: 5360 """""""""" 5361 5362 The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the 5363 same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same 5364 function. 5365 5366 Semantics: 5367 """""""""" 5368 5369 The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing 5370 (in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a 5371 :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction. 5372 5373 Example: 5374 """""""" 5375 5376 .. code-block:: llvm 5377 5378 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn 5379 5380 .. _i_catchswitch: 5381 5382 '``catchswitch``' Instruction 5383 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5384 5385 Syntax: 5386 """"""" 5387 5388 :: 5389 5390 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller 5391 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default> 5392 5393 Overview: 5394 """"""""" 5395 5396 The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system 5397 <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers 5398 that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`. 5399 5400 Arguments: 5401 """""""""" 5402 5403 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the 5404 ``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet, 5405 this operand may be the token ``none``. 5406 5407 The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with a 5408 "pad" instruction, one of ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch``. 5409 5410 The ``handlers`` are a list of successor blocks that each begin with a 5411 :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. 5412 5413 Semantics: 5414 """""""""" 5415 5416 Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in 5417 ``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if 5418 present. 5419 5420 The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that 5421 it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic 5422 block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block. 5423 5424 Example: 5425 """""""" 5426 5427 .. code-block:: llvm 5428 5429 dispatch1: 5430 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller 5431 dispatch2: 5432 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup 5433 5434 .. _i_catchpad: 5435 5436 '``catchpad``' Instruction 5437 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5438 5439 Syntax: 5440 """"""" 5441 5442 :: 5443 5444 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*] 5445 5446 Overview: 5447 """"""""" 5448 5449 The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling 5450 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block 5451 begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer 5452 control to catch an exception. 5453 5454 Arguments: 5455 """""""""" 5456 5457 The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a 5458 :ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This 5459 ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always 5460 terminates in a ``catchswitch``. 5461 5462 The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine 5463 requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control 5464 will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for 5465 the exception. 5466 5467 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the 5468 ``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH 5469 pads. 5470 5471 Semantics: 5472 """""""""" 5473 5474 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the 5475 exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will 5476 not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is 5477 entirely target and personality function-specific. 5478 5479 Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad`` 5480 instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block. 5481 5482 The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad" 5483 instructions is described in the 5484 `Windows exception handling documentation <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`. 5485 5486 Executing a ``catchpad`` instruction constitutes "entering" that pad. 5487 The pad may then be "exited" in one of three ways: 5488 5489 1) explicitly via a ``catchret`` that consumes it. Executing such a ``catchret`` 5490 is undefined behavior if any descendant pads have been entered but not yet 5491 exited. 5492 2) implicitly via a call (which unwinds all the way to the current function's caller), 5493 or via a ``catchswitch`` or a ``cleanupret`` that unwinds to caller. 5494 3) implicitly via an unwind edge whose destination EH pad isn't a descendant of 5495 the ``catchpad``. When the ``catchpad`` is exited in this manner, it is 5496 undefined behavior if the destination EH pad has a parent which is not an 5497 ancestor of the ``catchpad`` being exited. 5498 5499 Example: 5500 """""""" 5501 5502 .. code-block:: llvm 5503 5504 dispatch: 5505 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller 5506 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer. 5507 handler0: 5508 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi] 5509 5510 .. _i_catchret: 5511 5512 '``catchret``' Instruction 5513 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5514 5515 Syntax: 5516 """"""" 5517 5518 :: 5519 5520 catchret from <token> to label <normal> 5521 5522 Overview: 5523 """"""""" 5524 5525 The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a 5526 single successor. 5527 5528 5529 Arguments: 5530 """""""""" 5531 5532 The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it 5533 exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`. 5534 The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will 5535 transfer to next. 5536 5537 Semantics: 5538 """""""""" 5539 5540 The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose 5541 unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The 5542 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary 5543 code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to 5544 ``normal``. 5545 5546 The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a dominating ``catchpad`` 5547 instruction. The ``catchret`` destroys the physical frame established by 5548 ``catchpad``, so executing multiple returns on the same token without 5549 re-executing the ``catchpad`` will result in undefined behavior. 5550 See :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` for more details. 5551 5552 Example: 5553 """""""" 5554 5555 .. code-block:: llvm 5556 5557 catchret from %catch label %continue 5558 5559 .. _i_cleanupret: 5560 5561 '``cleanupret``' Instruction 5562 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5563 5564 Syntax: 5565 """"""" 5566 5567 :: 5568 5569 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue> 5570 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller 5571 5572 Overview: 5573 """"""""" 5574 5575 The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has 5576 an optional successor. 5577 5578 5579 Arguments: 5580 """""""""" 5581 5582 The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates 5583 which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`. 5584 It also has an optional successor, ``continue``. 5585 5586 Semantics: 5587 """""""""" 5588 5589 The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the 5590 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one 5591 :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended. 5592 It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function. 5593 5594 The unwind destination ``continue``, if present, must be an EH pad 5595 whose parent is either ``none`` or an ancestor of the ``cleanuppad`` 5596 being returned from. This constitutes an exceptional exit from all 5597 ancestors of the completed ``cleanuppad``, up to but not including 5598 the parent of ``continue``. 5599 See :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` for more details. 5600 5601 Example: 5602 """""""" 5603 5604 .. code-block:: llvm 5605 5606 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller 5607 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue 5608 5609 .. _i_unreachable: 5610 5611 '``unreachable``' Instruction 5612 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5613 5614 Syntax: 5615 """"""" 5616 5617 :: 5618 5619 unreachable 5620 5621 Overview: 5622 """"""""" 5623 5624 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This 5625 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of 5626 the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code 5627 after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts. 5628 5629 Semantics: 5630 """""""""" 5631 5632 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. 5633 5634 .. _binaryops: 5635 5636 Binary Operations 5637 ----------------- 5638 5639 Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program. 5640 They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on 5641 them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple 5642 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The 5643 result value has the same type as its operands. 5644 5645 There are several different binary operators: 5646 5647 .. _i_add: 5648 5649 '``add``' Instruction 5650 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5651 5652 Syntax: 5653 """"""" 5654 5655 :: 5656 5657 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5658 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5659 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5660 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5661 5662 Overview: 5663 """"""""" 5664 5665 The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands. 5666 5667 Arguments: 5668 """""""""" 5669 5670 The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be 5671 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 5672 arguments must have identical types. 5673 5674 Semantics: 5675 """""""""" 5676 5677 The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands. 5678 5679 If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the 5680 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of 5681 the result. 5682 5683 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this 5684 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers. 5685 5686 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap", 5687 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the 5688 result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if 5689 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs. 5690 5691 Example: 5692 """""""" 5693 5694 .. code-block:: llvm 5695 5696 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var 5697 5698 .. _i_fadd: 5699 5700 '``fadd``' Instruction 5701 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5702 5703 Syntax: 5704 """"""" 5705 5706 :: 5707 5708 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5709 5710 Overview: 5711 """"""""" 5712 5713 The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands. 5714 5715 Arguments: 5716 """""""""" 5717 5718 The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be :ref:`floating 5719 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values. 5720 Both arguments must have identical types. 5721 5722 Semantics: 5723 """""""""" 5724 5725 The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands. This 5726 instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, 5727 which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point 5728 optimizations: 5729 5730 Example: 5731 """""""" 5732 5733 .. code-block:: llvm 5734 5735 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var 5736 5737 '``sub``' Instruction 5738 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5739 5740 Syntax: 5741 """"""" 5742 5743 :: 5744 5745 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5746 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5747 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5748 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5749 5750 Overview: 5751 """"""""" 5752 5753 The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands. 5754 5755 Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``' 5756 instruction present in most other intermediate representations. 5757 5758 Arguments: 5759 """""""""" 5760 5761 The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be 5762 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 5763 arguments must have identical types. 5764 5765 Semantics: 5766 """""""""" 5767 5768 The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands. 5769 5770 If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the 5771 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of 5772 the result. 5773 5774 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this 5775 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers. 5776 5777 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap", 5778 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the 5779 result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if 5780 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs. 5781 5782 Example: 5783 """""""" 5784 5785 .. code-block:: llvm 5786 5787 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var 5788 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var 5789 5790 .. _i_fsub: 5791 5792 '``fsub``' Instruction 5793 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5794 5795 Syntax: 5796 """"""" 5797 5798 :: 5799 5800 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5801 5802 Overview: 5803 """"""""" 5804 5805 The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands. 5806 5807 Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``' 5808 instruction present in most other intermediate representations. 5809 5810 Arguments: 5811 """""""""" 5812 5813 The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be :ref:`floating 5814 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values. 5815 Both arguments must have identical types. 5816 5817 Semantics: 5818 """""""""" 5819 5820 The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands. 5821 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math 5822 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise 5823 unsafe floating point optimizations: 5824 5825 Example: 5826 """""""" 5827 5828 .. code-block:: llvm 5829 5830 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var 5831 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var 5832 5833 '``mul``' Instruction 5834 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5835 5836 Syntax: 5837 """"""" 5838 5839 :: 5840 5841 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5842 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5843 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5844 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5845 5846 Overview: 5847 """"""""" 5848 5849 The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands. 5850 5851 Arguments: 5852 """""""""" 5853 5854 The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be 5855 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 5856 arguments must have identical types. 5857 5858 Semantics: 5859 """""""""" 5860 5861 The value produced is the integer product of the two operands. 5862 5863 If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result 5864 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the 5865 bit width of the result. 5866 5867 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the 5868 result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the 5869 correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product 5870 (e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be 5871 sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full 5872 product. 5873 5874 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap", 5875 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the 5876 result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if 5877 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs. 5878 5879 Example: 5880 """""""" 5881 5882 .. code-block:: llvm 5883 5884 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var 5885 5886 .. _i_fmul: 5887 5888 '``fmul``' Instruction 5889 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5890 5891 Syntax: 5892 """"""" 5893 5894 :: 5895 5896 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5897 5898 Overview: 5899 """"""""" 5900 5901 The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands. 5902 5903 Arguments: 5904 """""""""" 5905 5906 The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be :ref:`floating 5907 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values. 5908 Both arguments must have identical types. 5909 5910 Semantics: 5911 """""""""" 5912 5913 The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands. 5914 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math 5915 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise 5916 unsafe floating point optimizations: 5917 5918 Example: 5919 """""""" 5920 5921 .. code-block:: llvm 5922 5923 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var 5924 5925 '``udiv``' Instruction 5926 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5927 5928 Syntax: 5929 """"""" 5930 5931 :: 5932 5933 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5934 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5935 5936 Overview: 5937 """"""""" 5938 5939 The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands. 5940 5941 Arguments: 5942 """""""""" 5943 5944 The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be 5945 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 5946 arguments must have identical types. 5947 5948 Semantics: 5949 """""""""" 5950 5951 The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands. 5952 5953 Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are 5954 distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'. 5955 5956 Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. 5957 5958 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is 5959 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as 5960 such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a"). 5961 5962 Example: 5963 """""""" 5964 5965 .. code-block:: llvm 5966 5967 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var 5968 5969 '``sdiv``' Instruction 5970 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 5971 5972 Syntax: 5973 """"""" 5974 5975 :: 5976 5977 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5978 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 5979 5980 Overview: 5981 """"""""" 5982 5983 The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands. 5984 5985 Arguments: 5986 """""""""" 5987 5988 The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be 5989 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 5990 arguments must have identical types. 5991 5992 Semantics: 5993 """""""""" 5994 5995 The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands 5996 rounded towards zero. 5997 5998 Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are 5999 distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'. 6000 6001 Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to 6002 undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by 6003 doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1. 6004 6005 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is 6006 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded. 6007 6008 Example: 6009 """""""" 6010 6011 .. code-block:: llvm 6012 6013 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var 6014 6015 .. _i_fdiv: 6016 6017 '``fdiv``' Instruction 6018 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6019 6020 Syntax: 6021 """"""" 6022 6023 :: 6024 6025 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6026 6027 Overview: 6028 """"""""" 6029 6030 The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands. 6031 6032 Arguments: 6033 """""""""" 6034 6035 The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be :ref:`floating 6036 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values. 6037 Both arguments must have identical types. 6038 6039 Semantics: 6040 """""""""" 6041 6042 The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands. 6043 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math 6044 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise 6045 unsafe floating point optimizations: 6046 6047 Example: 6048 """""""" 6049 6050 .. code-block:: llvm 6051 6052 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var 6053 6054 '``urem``' Instruction 6055 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6056 6057 Syntax: 6058 """"""" 6059 6060 :: 6061 6062 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6063 6064 Overview: 6065 """"""""" 6066 6067 The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned 6068 division of its two arguments. 6069 6070 Arguments: 6071 """""""""" 6072 6073 The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be 6074 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 6075 arguments must have identical types. 6076 6077 Semantics: 6078 """""""""" 6079 6080 This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division. 6081 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the 6082 remainder. 6083 6084 Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are 6085 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'. 6086 6087 Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior. 6088 6089 Example: 6090 """""""" 6091 6092 .. code-block:: llvm 6093 6094 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var 6095 6096 '``srem``' Instruction 6097 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6098 6099 Syntax: 6100 """"""" 6101 6102 :: 6103 6104 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6105 6106 Overview: 6107 """"""""" 6108 6109 The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed 6110 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take 6111 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements 6112 must be integers. 6113 6114 Arguments: 6115 """""""""" 6116 6117 The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be 6118 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 6119 arguments must have identical types. 6120 6121 Semantics: 6122 """""""""" 6123 6124 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result 6125 is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the 6126 *modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign 6127 as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the 6128 difference, see `The Math 6129 Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a 6130 table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see 6131 `Wikipedia: modulo 6132 operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_. 6133 6134 Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are 6135 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'. 6136 6137 Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior. 6138 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can 6139 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of 6140 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this 6141 rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the 6142 result of the division and the remainder.) 6143 6144 Example: 6145 """""""" 6146 6147 .. code-block:: llvm 6148 6149 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var 6150 6151 .. _i_frem: 6152 6153 '``frem``' Instruction 6154 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6155 6156 Syntax: 6157 """"""" 6158 6159 :: 6160 6161 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6162 6163 Overview: 6164 """"""""" 6165 6166 The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of 6167 its two operands. 6168 6169 Arguments: 6170 """""""""" 6171 6172 The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be :ref:`floating 6173 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values. 6174 Both arguments must have identical types. 6175 6176 Semantics: 6177 """""""""" 6178 6179 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division. The remainder 6180 has the same sign as the dividend. This instruction can also take any 6181 number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints 6182 to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations: 6183 6184 Example: 6185 """""""" 6186 6187 .. code-block:: llvm 6188 6189 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var 6190 6191 .. _bitwiseops: 6192 6193 Bitwise Binary Operations 6194 ------------------------- 6195 6196 Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling 6197 in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can 6198 commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two 6199 operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a 6200 single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands. 6201 6202 '``shl``' Instruction 6203 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6204 6205 Syntax: 6206 """"""" 6207 6208 :: 6209 6210 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6211 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6212 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6213 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6214 6215 Overview: 6216 """"""""" 6217 6218 The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left 6219 a specified number of bits. 6220 6221 Arguments: 6222 """""""""" 6223 6224 Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same 6225 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type. 6226 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value. 6227 6228 Semantics: 6229 """""""""" 6230 6231 The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`, 6232 where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or 6233 dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in 6234 ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the arguments are vectors, each 6235 vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount 6236 in ``op2``. 6237 6238 If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison 6239 value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any non-zero bits. If the 6240 ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison 6241 value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the 6242 resultant sign bit. As such, NUW/NSW have the same semantics as they 6243 would if the shift were expressed as a mul instruction with the same 6244 nsw/nuw bits in (mul %op1, (shl 1, %op2)). 6245 6246 Example: 6247 """""""" 6248 6249 .. code-block:: llvm 6250 6251 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var 6252 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16 6253 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024 6254 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined 6255 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4> 6256 6257 '``lshr``' Instruction 6258 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6259 6260 Syntax: 6261 """"""" 6262 6263 :: 6264 6265 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6266 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6267 6268 Overview: 6269 """"""""" 6270 6271 The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first 6272 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill. 6273 6274 Arguments: 6275 """""""""" 6276 6277 Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same 6278 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type. 6279 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value. 6280 6281 Semantics: 6282 """""""""" 6283 6284 This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The 6285 most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after 6286 the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger 6287 than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the 6288 arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the 6289 corresponding shift amount in ``op2``. 6290 6291 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is 6292 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are 6293 non-zero. 6294 6295 Example: 6296 """""""" 6297 6298 .. code-block:: llvm 6299 6300 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2 6301 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1 6302 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0 6303 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F 6304 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined 6305 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1> 6306 6307 '``ashr``' Instruction 6308 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6309 6310 Syntax: 6311 """"""" 6312 6313 :: 6314 6315 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6316 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6317 6318 Overview: 6319 """"""""" 6320 6321 The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first 6322 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign 6323 extension. 6324 6325 Arguments: 6326 """""""""" 6327 6328 Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same 6329 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type. 6330 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value. 6331 6332 Semantics: 6333 """""""""" 6334 6335 This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation, 6336 The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit 6337 of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger 6338 than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the 6339 arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the 6340 corresponding shift amount in ``op2``. 6341 6342 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is 6343 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are 6344 non-zero. 6345 6346 Example: 6347 """""""" 6348 6349 .. code-block:: llvm 6350 6351 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2 6352 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1 6353 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0 6354 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1 6355 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined 6356 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0> 6357 6358 '``and``' Instruction 6359 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6360 6361 Syntax: 6362 """"""" 6363 6364 :: 6365 6366 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6367 6368 Overview: 6369 """"""""" 6370 6371 The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two 6372 operands. 6373 6374 Arguments: 6375 """""""""" 6376 6377 The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be 6378 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 6379 arguments must have identical types. 6380 6381 Semantics: 6382 """""""""" 6383 6384 The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is: 6385 6386 +-----+-----+-----+ 6387 | In0 | In1 | Out | 6388 +-----+-----+-----+ 6389 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 6390 +-----+-----+-----+ 6391 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 6392 +-----+-----+-----+ 6393 | 1 | 0 | 0 | 6394 +-----+-----+-----+ 6395 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 6396 +-----+-----+-----+ 6397 6398 Example: 6399 """""""" 6400 6401 .. code-block:: llvm 6402 6403 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var 6404 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8 6405 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0 6406 6407 '``or``' Instruction 6408 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6409 6410 Syntax: 6411 """"""" 6412 6413 :: 6414 6415 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6416 6417 Overview: 6418 """"""""" 6419 6420 The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its 6421 two operands. 6422 6423 Arguments: 6424 """""""""" 6425 6426 The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be 6427 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 6428 arguments must have identical types. 6429 6430 Semantics: 6431 """""""""" 6432 6433 The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is: 6434 6435 +-----+-----+-----+ 6436 | In0 | In1 | Out | 6437 +-----+-----+-----+ 6438 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 6439 +-----+-----+-----+ 6440 | 0 | 1 | 1 | 6441 +-----+-----+-----+ 6442 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 6443 +-----+-----+-----+ 6444 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 6445 +-----+-----+-----+ 6446 6447 Example: 6448 """""""" 6449 6450 :: 6451 6452 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var 6453 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47 6454 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12 6455 6456 '``xor``' Instruction 6457 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6458 6459 Syntax: 6460 """"""" 6461 6462 :: 6463 6464 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result 6465 6466 Overview: 6467 """"""""" 6468 6469 The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of 6470 its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's 6471 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C. 6472 6473 Arguments: 6474 """""""""" 6475 6476 The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be 6477 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both 6478 arguments must have identical types. 6479 6480 Semantics: 6481 """""""""" 6482 6483 The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is: 6484 6485 +-----+-----+-----+ 6486 | In0 | In1 | Out | 6487 +-----+-----+-----+ 6488 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 6489 +-----+-----+-----+ 6490 | 0 | 1 | 1 | 6491 +-----+-----+-----+ 6492 | 1 | 0 | 1 | 6493 +-----+-----+-----+ 6494 | 1 | 1 | 0 | 6495 +-----+-----+-----+ 6496 6497 Example: 6498 """""""" 6499 6500 .. code-block:: llvm 6501 6502 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var 6503 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39 6504 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12 6505 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V 6506 6507 Vector Operations 6508 ----------------- 6509 6510 LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a 6511 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access 6512 and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively. 6513 While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many 6514 sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to 6515 take full advantage of a specific target. 6516 6517 .. _i_extractelement: 6518 6519 '``extractelement``' Instruction 6520 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6521 6522 Syntax: 6523 """"""" 6524 6525 :: 6526 6527 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty> 6528 6529 Overview: 6530 """"""""" 6531 6532 The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element 6533 from a vector at a specified index. 6534 6535 Arguments: 6536 """""""""" 6537 6538 The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of 6539 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating 6540 the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a 6541 variable of any integer type. 6542 6543 Semantics: 6544 """""""""" 6545 6546 The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``. 6547 Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx`` 6548 exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are undefined. 6549 6550 Example: 6551 """""""" 6552 6553 .. code-block:: llvm 6554 6555 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32 6556 6557 .. _i_insertelement: 6558 6559 '``insertelement``' Instruction 6560 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6561 6562 Syntax: 6563 """"""" 6564 6565 :: 6566 6567 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>> 6568 6569 Overview: 6570 """"""""" 6571 6572 The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a 6573 vector at a specified index. 6574 6575 Arguments: 6576 """""""""" 6577 6578 The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of 6579 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose 6580 type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand 6581 is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The 6582 index may be a variable of any integer type. 6583 6584 Semantics: 6585 """""""""" 6586 6587 The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values 6588 are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value 6589 ``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are 6590 undefined. 6591 6592 Example: 6593 """""""" 6594 6595 .. code-block:: llvm 6596 6597 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32> 6598 6599 .. _i_shufflevector: 6600 6601 '``shufflevector``' Instruction 6602 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6603 6604 Syntax: 6605 """"""" 6606 6607 :: 6608 6609 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>> 6610 6611 Overview: 6612 """"""""" 6613 6614 The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements 6615 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as 6616 the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask. 6617 6618 Arguments: 6619 """""""""" 6620 6621 The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors 6622 with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element 6623 type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose 6624 length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the 6625 same as the element type of the first two operands. 6626 6627 The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either 6628 constant integer or undef values. 6629 6630 Semantics: 6631 """""""""" 6632 6633 The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right 6634 across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each 6635 element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the 6636 result element gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning "don't 6637 care") and the second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from 6638 only one vector. 6639 6640 Example: 6641 """""""" 6642 6643 .. code-block:: llvm 6644 6645 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2, 6646 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32> 6647 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef, 6648 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle. 6649 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef, 6650 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> 6651 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2, 6652 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32> 6653 6654 Aggregate Operations 6655 -------------------- 6656 6657 LLVM supports several instructions for working with 6658 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values. 6659 6660 .. _i_extractvalue: 6661 6662 '``extractvalue``' Instruction 6663 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6664 6665 Syntax: 6666 """"""" 6667 6668 :: 6669 6670 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}* 6671 6672 Overview: 6673 """"""""" 6674 6675 The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field 6676 from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value. 6677 6678 Arguments: 6679 """""""""" 6680 6681 The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of 6682 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are 6683 constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner 6684 as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction. 6685 6686 The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are: 6687 6688 - Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is 6689 omitted and assumed to be zero. 6690 - At least one index must be specified. 6691 - Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds. 6692 6693 Semantics: 6694 """""""""" 6695 6696 The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by 6697 the index operands. 6698 6699 Example: 6700 """""""" 6701 6702 .. code-block:: llvm 6703 6704 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32 6705 6706 .. _i_insertvalue: 6707 6708 '``insertvalue``' Instruction 6709 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6710 6711 Syntax: 6712 """"""" 6713 6714 :: 6715 6716 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type> 6717 6718 Overview: 6719 """"""""" 6720 6721 The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in 6722 an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value. 6723 6724 Arguments: 6725 """""""""" 6726 6727 The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of 6728 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is 6729 a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant 6730 indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a 6731 similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value 6732 to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the 6733 indices. 6734 6735 Semantics: 6736 """""""""" 6737 6738 The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is 6739 that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the 6740 indices is that of ``elt``. 6741 6742 Example: 6743 """""""" 6744 6745 .. code-block:: llvm 6746 6747 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef} 6748 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val} 6749 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}} 6750 6751 .. _memoryops: 6752 6753 Memory Access and Addressing Operations 6754 --------------------------------------- 6755 6756 A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents 6757 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things 6758 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate 6759 memory in LLVM. 6760 6761 .. _i_alloca: 6762 6763 '``alloca``' Instruction 6764 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6765 6766 Syntax: 6767 """"""" 6768 6769 :: 6770 6771 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] ; yields type*:result 6772 6773 Overview: 6774 """"""""" 6775 6776 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the 6777 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this 6778 function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the 6779 generic address space (address space zero). 6780 6781 Arguments: 6782 """""""""" 6783 6784 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements`` 6785 bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the 6786 appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is 6787 the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted 6788 to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the 6789 allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The 6790 alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if 6791 zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient 6792 boundary compatible with the type. 6793 6794 '``type``' may be any sized type. 6795 6796 Semantics: 6797 """""""""" 6798 6799 Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined 6800 if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d 6801 memory is automatically released when the function returns. The 6802 '``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic 6803 variables that must have an address available. When the function returns 6804 (either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is 6805 reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined. 6806 The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows) 6807 is not specified. 6808 6809 Example: 6810 """""""" 6811 6812 .. code-block:: llvm 6813 6814 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr 6815 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr 6816 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr 6817 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr 6818 6819 .. _i_load: 6820 6821 '``load``' Instruction 6822 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6823 6824 Syntax: 6825 """"""" 6826 6827 :: 6828 6829 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>] 6830 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] 6831 !<index> = !{ i32 1 } 6832 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>} 6833 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> } 6834 6835 Overview: 6836 """"""""" 6837 6838 The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory. 6839 6840 Arguments: 6841 """""""""" 6842 6843 The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address 6844 from which to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first 6845 class <t_firstclass>` type. If the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, 6846 then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of 6847 execution of this ``load`` with other :ref:`volatile 6848 operations <volatile>`. 6849 6850 If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering 6851 <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The ``release`` and 6852 ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions. Atomic loads 6853 produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see multiple atomic 6854 stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point 6855 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less 6856 than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be explicitly 6857 specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the alignment 6858 is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the 6859 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads. 6860 6861 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the 6862 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0 6863 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI 6864 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter 6865 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the 6866 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment 6867 may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The 6868 maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. 6869 6870 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single 6871 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one 6872 ``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` 6873 metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator 6874 that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code 6875 generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such 6876 as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86. 6877 6878 The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single 6879 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no 6880 entries. The existence of the ``!invariant.load`` metadata on the 6881 instruction tells the optimizer and code generator that the address 6882 operand to this load points to memory which can be assumed unchanged. 6883 Being invariant does not imply that a location is dereferenceable, 6884 but it does imply that once the location is known dereferenceable 6885 its value is henceforth unchanging. 6886 6887 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name 6888 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node. See ``invariant.group`` metadata. 6889 6890 The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single 6891 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no 6892 entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the 6893 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to 6894 never be null. This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute 6895 on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied 6896 to loads of a pointer type. 6897 6898 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata 6899 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` 6900 entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction 6901 tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable. 6902 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer 6903 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable'' 6904 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied 6905 to loads of a pointer type. 6906 6907 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single 6908 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one 6909 ``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the 6910 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either 6911 dereferenceable or null. 6912 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer 6913 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null'' 6914 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied 6915 to loads of a pointer type. 6916 6917 The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name 6918 ``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry. 6919 The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the 6920 optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified 6921 by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2. 6922 This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values. 6923 This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type. 6924 6925 Semantics: 6926 """""""""" 6927 6928 The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded 6929 is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the 6930 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For 6931 example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a 6932 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number 6933 of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally 6934 written using a store of the same type. 6935 6936 Examples: 6937 """"""""" 6938 6939 .. code-block:: llvm 6940 6941 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr 6942 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void 6943 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3 6944 6945 .. _i_store: 6946 6947 '``store``' Instruction 6948 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 6949 6950 Syntax: 6951 """"""" 6952 6953 :: 6954 6955 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void 6956 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void 6957 6958 Overview: 6959 """"""""" 6960 6961 The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory. 6962 6963 Arguments: 6964 """""""""" 6965 6966 There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store 6967 and an address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` 6968 operand must be a pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of 6969 the ``<value>`` operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, 6970 then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of 6971 execution of this ``store`` with other :ref:`volatile 6972 operations <volatile>`. 6973 6974 If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering 6975 <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The ``acquire`` and 6976 ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions. Atomic loads 6977 produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see multiple atomic 6978 stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point 6979 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less 6980 than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be explicitly 6981 specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if the 6982 alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the 6983 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores. 6984 6985 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the 6986 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0 6987 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI 6988 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter 6989 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the 6990 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the 6991 alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always 6992 safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. 6993 6994 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata 6995 name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of 6996 value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction 6997 tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to 6998 be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special 6999 instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the MOVNT instruction on 7000 x86. 7001 7002 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a 7003 single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata. 7004 7005 Semantics: 7006 """""""""" 7007 7008 The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the 7009 location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is 7010 of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the 7011 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For 7012 example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a 7013 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number 7014 of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not 7015 belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten. 7016 7017 Example: 7018 """""""" 7019 7020 .. code-block:: llvm 7021 7022 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr 7023 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void 7024 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3 7025 7026 .. _i_fence: 7027 7028 '``fence``' Instruction 7029 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7030 7031 Syntax: 7032 """"""" 7033 7034 :: 7035 7036 fence [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields void 7037 7038 Overview: 7039 """"""""" 7040 7041 The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges 7042 between operations. 7043 7044 Arguments: 7045 """""""""" 7046 7047 '``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which 7048 defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given 7049 ``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings. 7050 7051 Semantics: 7052 """""""""" 7053 7054 A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics 7055 *synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering 7056 semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both 7057 operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X 7058 modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence 7059 headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a 7060 *happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit 7061 ``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might 7062 provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and 7063 still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the 7064 *happens-before* edge. 7065 7066 A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both 7067 ``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in 7068 the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences. 7069 7070 The optional ":ref:`singlethread <singlethread>`" argument specifies 7071 that the fence only synchronizes with other fences in the same thread. 7072 (This is useful for interacting with signal handlers.) 7073 7074 Example: 7075 """""""" 7076 7077 .. code-block:: llvm 7078 7079 fence acquire ; yields void 7080 fence singlethread seq_cst ; yields void 7081 7082 .. _i_cmpxchg: 7083 7084 '``cmpxchg``' Instruction 7085 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7086 7087 Syntax: 7088 """"""" 7089 7090 :: 7091 7092 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [singlethread] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 } 7093 7094 Overview: 7095 """"""""" 7096 7097 The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It 7098 loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are 7099 equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory. 7100 7101 Arguments: 7102 """""""""" 7103 7104 There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address 7105 to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that 7106 address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values 7107 are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer type whose bit width 7108 is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal 7109 to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must have the same 7110 type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to that type. If the 7111 ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed 7112 to modify the number or order of execution of this ``cmpxchg`` with 7113 other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. 7114 7115 The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this 7116 ``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters 7117 must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no 7118 stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either 7119 ``release`` or ``acq_rel``. 7120 7121 The optional "``singlethread``" argument declares that the ``cmpxchg`` 7122 is only atomic with respect to code (usually signal handlers) running in 7123 the same thread as the ``cmpxchg``. Otherwise the cmpxchg is atomic with 7124 respect to all other code in the system. 7125 7126 The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or 7127 equal to the size in memory of the operand. 7128 7129 Semantics: 7130 """""""""" 7131 7132 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand 7133 is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the read value is the equal, the 7134 '``<new>``' is written. The original value at the location is returned, together 7135 with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false). 7136 7137 If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is 7138 permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison 7139 matched. 7140 7141 If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only 7142 if the value loaded equals ``cmp``. 7143 7144 A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of 7145 identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic 7146 load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter. 7147 7148 Example: 7149 """""""" 7150 7151 .. code-block:: llvm 7152 7153 entry: 7154 %orig = atomic load i32, i32* %ptr unordered ; yields i32 7155 br label %loop 7156 7157 loop: 7158 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%old, %loop] 7159 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp 7160 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 } 7161 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0 7162 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1 7163 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop 7164 7165 done: 7166 ... 7167 7168 .. _i_atomicrmw: 7169 7170 '``atomicrmw``' Instruction 7171 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7172 7173 Syntax: 7174 """"""" 7175 7176 :: 7177 7178 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields ty 7179 7180 Overview: 7181 """"""""" 7182 7183 The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. 7184 7185 Arguments: 7186 """""""""" 7187 7188 There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an 7189 operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the 7190 operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords: 7191 7192 - xchg 7193 - add 7194 - sub 7195 - and 7196 - nand 7197 - or 7198 - xor 7199 - max 7200 - min 7201 - umax 7202 - umin 7203 7204 The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power 7205 of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a 7206 target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must 7207 be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as 7208 ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or 7209 order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile 7210 operations <volatile>`. 7211 7212 Semantics: 7213 """""""""" 7214 7215 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' 7216 operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original 7217 value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the 7218 operation argument: 7219 7220 - xchg: ``*ptr = val`` 7221 - add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val`` 7222 - sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val`` 7223 - and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val`` 7224 - nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)`` 7225 - or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val`` 7226 - xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val`` 7227 - max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison) 7228 - min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison) 7229 - umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned 7230 comparison) 7231 - umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned 7232 comparison) 7233 7234 Example: 7235 """""""" 7236 7237 .. code-block:: llvm 7238 7239 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32 7240 7241 .. _i_getelementptr: 7242 7243 '``getelementptr``' Instruction 7244 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7245 7246 Syntax: 7247 """"""" 7248 7249 :: 7250 7251 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}* 7252 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}* 7253 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, <vector index type> <idx> 7254 7255 Overview: 7256 """"""""" 7257 7258 The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a 7259 subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs 7260 address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also 7261 be used to calculate a vector of such addresses. 7262 7263 Arguments: 7264 """""""""" 7265 7266 The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations. 7267 The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the 7268 base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices 7269 that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed. 7270 The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed 7271 into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the 7272 first argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to 7273 (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index 7274 can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer 7275 value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that 7276 subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that 7277 would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation. 7278 7279 The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into. 7280 When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer 7281 **constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all 7282 be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array, 7283 pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not 7284 required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values 7285 where relevant. 7286 7287 For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled 7288 to LLVM: 7289 7290 .. code-block:: c 7291 7292 struct RT { 7293 char A; 7294 int B[10][20]; 7295 char C; 7296 }; 7297 struct ST { 7298 int X; 7299 double Y; 7300 struct RT Z; 7301 }; 7302 7303 int *foo(struct ST *s) { 7304 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13]; 7305 } 7306 7307 The LLVM code generated by Clang is: 7308 7309 .. code-block:: llvm 7310 7311 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 } 7312 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT } 7313 7314 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp { 7315 entry: 7316 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13 7317 ret i32* %arrayidx 7318 } 7319 7320 Semantics: 7321 """""""""" 7322 7323 In the example above, the first index is indexing into the 7324 '``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``' 7325 = '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index 7326 indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a 7327 '``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another 7328 structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the 7329 structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two 7330 dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``' 7331 type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this 7332 element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type. 7333 7334 Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure, 7335 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code 7336 for the given testcase is equivalent to: 7337 7338 .. code-block:: llvm 7339 7340 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) { 7341 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1 7342 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2 7343 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3 7344 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4 7345 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5 7346 ret i32* %t5 7347 } 7348 7349 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the 7350 ``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base 7351 pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any 7352 of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the 7353 offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely 7354 precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that 7355 allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are 7356 all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte 7357 past the end. In cases where the base is a vector of pointers the 7358 ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each of the computations element-wise. 7359 7360 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the 7361 base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the 7362 offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended 7363 or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the 7364 ``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base 7365 pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory 7366 though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the 7367 :ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more 7368 information. 7369 7370 The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight 7371 into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`. 7372 7373 Example: 7374 """""""" 7375 7376 .. code-block:: llvm 7377 7378 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr 7379 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1 7380 ; yields i8*:vptr 7381 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1 7382 ; yields i8*:eptr 7383 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1 7384 ; yields i32*:iptr 7385 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0 7386 7387 Vector of pointers: 7388 """"""""""""""""""" 7389 7390 The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address, 7391 when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector 7392 arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument 7393 will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation. 7394 7395 .. code-block:: llvm 7396 7397 ; All arguments are vectors: 7398 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8) 7399 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets 7400 7401 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector: 7402 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8) 7403 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset 7404 7405 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer: 7406 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8) 7407 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets 7408 7409 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*> 7410 7411 The two following instructions are equivalent: 7412 7413 .. code-block:: llvm 7414 7415 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1, 7416 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>, 7417 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>, 7418 <4 x i32> %ind4, 7419 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13> 7420 7421 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1, 7422 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13 7423 7424 Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr`` 7425 makes sense: 7426 7427 .. code-block:: c 7428 7429 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop: 7430 double *A, B; int *C; 7431 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) { 7432 A[i] = B[C[i]]; 7433 } 7434 7435 .. code-block:: llvm 7436 7437 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B 7438 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C 7439 ; load 8 elements from array B into A 7440 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs, 7441 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru) 7442 7443 Conversion Operations 7444 --------------------- 7445 7446 The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions 7447 (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform 7448 various bit conversions on the operand. 7449 7450 '``trunc .. to``' Instruction 7451 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7452 7453 Syntax: 7454 """"""" 7455 7456 :: 7457 7458 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7459 7460 Overview: 7461 """"""""" 7462 7463 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``. 7464 7465 Arguments: 7466 """""""""" 7467 7468 The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc 7469 it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors 7470 of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be 7471 larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized 7472 types are not allowed. 7473 7474 Semantics: 7475 """""""""" 7476 7477 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value`` 7478 and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must 7479 be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*. 7480 It will always truncate bits. 7481 7482 Example: 7483 """""""" 7484 7485 .. code-block:: llvm 7486 7487 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1 7488 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true 7489 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false 7490 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7> 7491 7492 '``zext .. to``' Instruction 7493 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7494 7495 Syntax: 7496 """"""" 7497 7498 :: 7499 7500 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7501 7502 Overview: 7503 """"""""" 7504 7505 The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``. 7506 7507 Arguments: 7508 """""""""" 7509 7510 The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it 7511 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of 7512 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be 7513 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. 7514 7515 Semantics: 7516 """""""""" 7517 7518 The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits 7519 until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``. 7520 7521 When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1. 7522 7523 Example: 7524 """""""" 7525 7526 .. code-block:: llvm 7527 7528 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257 7529 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1 7530 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7> 7531 7532 '``sext .. to``' Instruction 7533 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7534 7535 Syntax: 7536 """"""" 7537 7538 :: 7539 7540 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7541 7542 Overview: 7543 """"""""" 7544 7545 The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``. 7546 7547 Arguments: 7548 """""""""" 7549 7550 The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it 7551 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of 7552 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be 7553 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. 7554 7555 Semantics: 7556 """""""""" 7557 7558 The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign 7559 bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size 7560 of the type ``ty2``. 7561 7562 When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0. 7563 7564 Example: 7565 """""""" 7566 7567 .. code-block:: llvm 7568 7569 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535 7570 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1 7571 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7> 7572 7573 '``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction 7574 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7575 7576 Syntax: 7577 """"""" 7578 7579 :: 7580 7581 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7582 7583 Overview: 7584 """"""""" 7585 7586 The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``. 7587 7588 Arguments: 7589 """""""""" 7590 7591 The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` 7592 value to cast and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it to. 7593 The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This 7594 implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*. 7595 7596 Semantics: 7597 """""""""" 7598 7599 The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger 7600 :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating 7601 point <t_floating>` type. If the value cannot fit (i.e. overflows) within the 7602 destination type, ``ty2``, then the results are undefined. If the cast produces 7603 an inexact result, how rounding is performed (e.g. truncation, also known as 7604 round to zero) is undefined. 7605 7606 Example: 7607 """""""" 7608 7609 .. code-block:: llvm 7610 7611 %X = fptrunc double 123.0 to float ; yields float:123.0 7612 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to float ; yields undefined 7613 7614 '``fpext .. to``' Instruction 7615 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7616 7617 Syntax: 7618 """"""" 7619 7620 :: 7621 7622 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7623 7624 Overview: 7625 """"""""" 7626 7627 The '``fpext``' extends a floating point ``value`` to a larger floating 7628 point value. 7629 7630 Arguments: 7631 """""""""" 7632 7633 The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` 7634 ``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it 7635 to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type. 7636 7637 Semantics: 7638 """""""""" 7639 7640 The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller 7641 :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating 7642 point <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a 7643 *no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a 7644 *no-op cast* for a floating point cast. 7645 7646 Example: 7647 """""""" 7648 7649 .. code-block:: llvm 7650 7651 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00 7652 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000 7653 7654 '``fptoui .. to``' Instruction 7655 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7656 7657 Syntax: 7658 """"""" 7659 7660 :: 7661 7662 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7663 7664 Overview: 7665 """"""""" 7666 7667 The '``fptoui``' converts a floating point ``value`` to its unsigned 7668 integer equivalent of type ``ty2``. 7669 7670 Arguments: 7671 """""""""" 7672 7673 The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a 7674 scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to 7675 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If 7676 ``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer 7677 type with the same number of elements as ``ty`` 7678 7679 Semantics: 7680 """""""""" 7681 7682 The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating 7683 point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero) 7684 unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results 7685 are undefined. 7686 7687 Example: 7688 """""""" 7689 7690 .. code-block:: llvm 7691 7692 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123 7693 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1 7694 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1 7695 7696 '``fptosi .. to``' Instruction 7697 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7698 7699 Syntax: 7700 """"""" 7701 7702 :: 7703 7704 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7705 7706 Overview: 7707 """"""""" 7708 7709 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` 7710 ``value`` to type ``ty2``. 7711 7712 Arguments: 7713 """""""""" 7714 7715 The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a 7716 scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to 7717 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If 7718 ``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer 7719 type with the same number of elements as ``ty`` 7720 7721 Semantics: 7722 """""""""" 7723 7724 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating 7725 point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero) 7726 signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results 7727 are undefined. 7728 7729 Example: 7730 """""""" 7731 7732 .. code-block:: llvm 7733 7734 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123 7735 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1 7736 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1 7737 7738 '``uitofp .. to``' Instruction 7739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7740 7741 Syntax: 7742 """"""" 7743 7744 :: 7745 7746 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7747 7748 Overview: 7749 """"""""" 7750 7751 The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer 7752 and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type. 7753 7754 Arguments: 7755 """""""""" 7756 7757 The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a 7758 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to 7759 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If 7760 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point 7761 type with the same number of elements as ``ty`` 7762 7763 Semantics: 7764 """""""""" 7765 7766 The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned 7767 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point 7768 value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results 7769 are undefined. 7770 7771 Example: 7772 """""""" 7773 7774 .. code-block:: llvm 7775 7776 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0 7777 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0 7778 7779 '``sitofp .. to``' Instruction 7780 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7781 7782 Syntax: 7783 """"""" 7784 7785 :: 7786 7787 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7788 7789 Overview: 7790 """"""""" 7791 7792 The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and 7793 converts that value to the ``ty2`` type. 7794 7795 Arguments: 7796 """""""""" 7797 7798 The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a 7799 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to 7800 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If 7801 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point 7802 type with the same number of elements as ``ty`` 7803 7804 Semantics: 7805 """""""""" 7806 7807 The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer 7808 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If 7809 the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are 7810 undefined. 7811 7812 Example: 7813 """""""" 7814 7815 .. code-block:: llvm 7816 7817 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0 7818 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0 7819 7820 .. _i_ptrtoint: 7821 7822 '``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction 7823 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7824 7825 Syntax: 7826 """"""" 7827 7828 :: 7829 7830 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7831 7832 Overview: 7833 """"""""" 7834 7835 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of 7836 pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``. 7837 7838 Arguments: 7839 """""""""" 7840 7841 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be 7842 a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a 7843 type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or 7844 a vector of integers type. 7845 7846 Semantics: 7847 """""""""" 7848 7849 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type 7850 ``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either 7851 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type. 7852 If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If 7853 ``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are 7854 the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type 7855 change. 7856 7857 Example: 7858 """""""" 7859 7860 .. code-block:: llvm 7861 7862 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture 7863 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture 7864 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture 7865 7866 .. _i_inttoptr: 7867 7868 '``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction 7869 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7870 7871 Syntax: 7872 """"""" 7873 7874 :: 7875 7876 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7877 7878 Overview: 7879 """"""""" 7880 7881 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a 7882 pointer type, ``ty2``. 7883 7884 Arguments: 7885 """""""""" 7886 7887 The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to 7888 cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` 7889 type. 7890 7891 Semantics: 7892 """""""""" 7893 7894 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by 7895 applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size 7896 of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a 7897 pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size 7898 of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size, 7899 nothing is done (*no-op cast*). 7900 7901 Example: 7902 """""""" 7903 7904 .. code-block:: llvm 7905 7906 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture 7907 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture 7908 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture 7909 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers 7910 7911 .. _i_bitcast: 7912 7913 '``bitcast .. to``' Instruction 7914 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7915 7916 Syntax: 7917 """"""" 7918 7919 :: 7920 7921 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2 7922 7923 Overview: 7924 """"""""" 7925 7926 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without 7927 changing any bits. 7928 7929 Arguments: 7930 """""""""" 7931 7932 The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a 7933 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must 7934 also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The 7935 bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be 7936 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must 7937 also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise 7938 conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as 7939 long as they have the same size). 7940 7941 Semantics: 7942 """""""""" 7943 7944 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It 7945 is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this 7946 conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored 7947 to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of 7948 pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of 7949 pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction. 7950 To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>` 7951 or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first. 7952 7953 Example: 7954 """""""" 7955 7956 .. code-block:: llvm 7957 7958 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1 7959 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x 7960 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V 7961 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*> 7962 7963 .. _i_addrspacecast: 7964 7965 '``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction 7966 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 7967 7968 Syntax: 7969 """"""" 7970 7971 :: 7972 7973 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2 7974 7975 Overview: 7976 """"""""" 7977 7978 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in 7979 address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``. 7980 7981 Arguments: 7982 """""""""" 7983 7984 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value 7985 to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different 7986 address space. 7987 7988 Semantics: 7989 """""""""" 7990 7991 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value 7992 ``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex 7993 value modification, depending on the target and the address space 7994 pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be 7995 performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space 7996 conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory 7997 location. 7998 7999 Example: 8000 """""""" 8001 8002 .. code-block:: llvm 8003 8004 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x 8005 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y 8006 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z 8007 8008 .. _otherops: 8009 8010 Other Operations 8011 ---------------- 8012 8013 The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions, 8014 which defy better classification. 8015 8016 .. _i_icmp: 8017 8018 '``icmp``' Instruction 8019 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8020 8021 Syntax: 8022 """"""" 8023 8024 :: 8025 8026 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result 8027 8028 Overview: 8029 """"""""" 8030 8031 The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of 8032 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector, 8033 pointer, or pointer vector operands. 8034 8035 Arguments: 8036 """""""""" 8037 8038 The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is 8039 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is 8040 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are: 8041 8042 #. ``eq``: equal 8043 #. ``ne``: not equal 8044 #. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than 8045 #. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal 8046 #. ``ult``: unsigned less than 8047 #. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal 8048 #. ``sgt``: signed greater than 8049 #. ``sge``: signed greater or equal 8050 #. ``slt``: signed less than 8051 #. ``sle``: signed less or equal 8052 8053 The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or 8054 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They 8055 must also be identical types. 8056 8057 Semantics: 8058 """""""""" 8059 8060 The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition 8061 code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an 8062 :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows: 8063 8064 #. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false`` 8065 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed. 8066 #. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false`` 8067 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed. 8068 #. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields 8069 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``. 8070 #. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields 8071 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``. 8072 #. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields 8073 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``. 8074 #. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields 8075 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``. 8076 #. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true`` 8077 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``. 8078 #. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true`` 8079 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``. 8080 #. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true`` 8081 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``. 8082 #. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true`` 8083 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``. 8084 8085 If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values 8086 are compared as if they were integers. 8087 8088 If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by 8089 element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements 8090 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``. 8091 8092 Example: 8093 """""""" 8094 8095 .. code-block:: llvm 8096 8097 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false 8098 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false 8099 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true 8100 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false 8101 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false 8102 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false 8103 8104 Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the 8105 ``icmp`` instruction. 8106 8107 .. _i_fcmp: 8108 8109 '``fcmp``' Instruction 8110 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8111 8112 Syntax: 8113 """"""" 8114 8115 :: 8116 8117 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result 8118 8119 Overview: 8120 """"""""" 8121 8122 The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean 8123 values based on comparison of its operands. 8124 8125 If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a 8126 boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`). 8127 8128 If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a 8129 vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being 8130 compared. 8131 8132 Arguments: 8133 """""""""" 8134 8135 The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is 8136 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is 8137 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are: 8138 8139 #. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false 8140 #. ``oeq``: ordered and equal 8141 #. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than 8142 #. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal 8143 #. ``olt``: ordered and less than 8144 #. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal 8145 #. ``one``: ordered and not equal 8146 #. ``ord``: ordered (no nans) 8147 #. ``ueq``: unordered or equal 8148 #. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than 8149 #. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal 8150 #. ``ult``: unordered or less than 8151 #. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal 8152 #. ``une``: unordered or not equal 8153 #. ``uno``: unordered (either nans) 8154 #. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true 8155 8156 *Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means 8157 that either operand may be a QNAN. 8158 8159 Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating 8160 point <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point 8161 type. They must have identical types. 8162 8163 Semantics: 8164 """""""""" 8165 8166 The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the 8167 condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the 8168 vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed 8169 always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows: 8170 8171 #. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands. 8172 #. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1`` 8173 is equal to ``op2``. 8174 #. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1`` 8175 is greater than ``op2``. 8176 #. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1`` 8177 is greater than or equal to ``op2``. 8178 #. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1`` 8179 is less than ``op2``. 8180 #. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1`` 8181 is less than or equal to ``op2``. 8182 #. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1`` 8183 is not equal to ``op2``. 8184 #. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN. 8185 #. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is 8186 equal to ``op2``. 8187 #. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is 8188 greater than ``op2``. 8189 #. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is 8190 greater than or equal to ``op2``. 8191 #. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is 8192 less than ``op2``. 8193 #. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is 8194 less than or equal to ``op2``. 8195 #. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is 8196 not equal to ``op2``. 8197 #. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN. 8198 #. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands. 8199 8200 The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of 8201 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable 8202 otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations. 8203 8204 Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the 8205 only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow 8206 assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely 8207 ``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``nsz``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information. 8208 8209 Example: 8210 """""""" 8211 8212 .. code-block:: llvm 8213 8214 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false 8215 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true 8216 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true 8217 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false 8218 8219 Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the 8220 ``fcmp`` instruction. 8221 8222 .. _i_phi: 8223 8224 '``phi``' Instruction 8225 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8226 8227 Syntax: 8228 """"""" 8229 8230 :: 8231 8232 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ... 8233 8234 Overview: 8235 """"""""" 8236 8237 The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the node in the SSA 8238 graph representing the function. 8239 8240 Arguments: 8241 """""""""" 8242 8243 The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field. 8244 After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as 8245 arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current 8246 block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as 8247 the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the 8248 label arguments. 8249 8250 There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block 8251 and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic 8252 block. 8253 8254 For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is 8255 deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to 8256 the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``' 8257 instruction's return value on the same edge). 8258 8259 Semantics: 8260 """""""""" 8261 8262 At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value 8263 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that 8264 executed just prior to the current block. 8265 8266 Example: 8267 """""""" 8268 8269 .. code-block:: llvm 8270 8271 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up... 8272 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ] 8273 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1 8274 br label %Loop 8275 8276 .. _i_select: 8277 8278 '``select``' Instruction 8279 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8280 8281 Syntax: 8282 """"""" 8283 8284 :: 8285 8286 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty 8287 8288 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>} 8289 8290 Overview: 8291 """"""""" 8292 8293 The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a 8294 condition, without IR-level branching. 8295 8296 Arguments: 8297 """""""""" 8298 8299 The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1' 8300 values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first 8301 class <t_firstclass>` type. 8302 8303 Semantics: 8304 """""""""" 8305 8306 If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns 8307 the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value 8308 argument. 8309 8310 If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be 8311 vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element. 8312 8313 If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the 8314 same size, then an entire vector is selected. 8315 8316 Example: 8317 """""""" 8318 8319 .. code-block:: llvm 8320 8321 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17 8322 8323 .. _i_call: 8324 8325 '``call``' Instruction 8326 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8327 8328 Syntax: 8329 """"""" 8330 8331 :: 8332 8333 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty> [<fnty>*] <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs] 8334 [ operand bundles ] 8335 8336 Overview: 8337 """"""""" 8338 8339 The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call. 8340 8341 Arguments: 8342 """""""""" 8343 8344 This instruction requires several arguments: 8345 8346 #. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers 8347 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that 8348 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker 8349 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to 8350 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees: 8351 8352 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a 8353 recursive cycle in the call graph. 8354 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are 8355 forwarded in place. 8356 8357 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas or varargs from 8358 the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following additional 8359 rules: 8360 8361 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction, 8362 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction. 8363 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value 8364 produced by the call or void. 8365 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of 8366 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not 8367 in address space. 8368 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match. 8369 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg, 8370 returned, and inalloca, must match. 8371 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a 8372 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so 8373 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules. 8374 8375 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if 8376 the following conditions are met: 8377 8378 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``. 8379 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret 8380 uses value of call or is void). 8381 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or 8382 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``. 8383 - `Platform-specific constraints are 8384 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_ 8385 8386 #. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add 8387 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail 8388 call optimization from being performed on the call. 8389 8390 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more 8391 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable 8392 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid 8393 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type. 8394 8395 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling 8396 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is 8397 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The 8398 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of 8399 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined. 8400 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return 8401 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes 8402 are valid here. 8403 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the 8404 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked 8405 ``void``. 8406 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to function value 8407 being invoked. The argument types must match the types implied by 8408 this signature. This type can be omitted if the function is not 8409 varargs and if the function type does not return a pointer to a 8410 function. 8411 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to 8412 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but 8413 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer 8414 to function value. 8415 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function 8416 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must 8417 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature 8418 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the 8419 extra arguments can be specified. 8420 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only 8421 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``' 8422 attributes are valid here. 8423 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list. 8424 8425 Semantics: 8426 """""""""" 8427 8428 The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to 8429 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified 8430 values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control 8431 flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the 8432 return value of the function is bound to the result argument. 8433 8434 Example: 8435 """""""" 8436 8437 .. code-block:: llvm 8438 8439 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc) 8440 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32 8441 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32 8442 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32 8443 call void %foo(i8 97 signext) 8444 8445 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 } 8446 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 } 8447 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32 8448 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8 8449 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally 8450 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended 8451 8452 llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match 8453 the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may 8454 perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption. 8455 This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better 8456 support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages. 8457 8458 .. _i_va_arg: 8459 8460 '``va_arg``' Instruction 8461 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8462 8463 Syntax: 8464 """"""" 8465 8466 :: 8467 8468 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty> 8469 8470 Overview: 8471 """"""""" 8472 8473 The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through 8474 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement 8475 the ``va_arg`` macro in C. 8476 8477 Arguments: 8478 """""""""" 8479 8480 This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the 8481 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and 8482 increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual 8483 type of ``va_list`` is target specific. 8484 8485 Semantics: 8486 """""""""" 8487 8488 The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type 8489 from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to 8490 the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument 8491 handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`. 8492 8493 It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does 8494 not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf`` 8495 function. 8496 8497 ``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic 8498 function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument. 8499 8500 Example: 8501 """""""" 8502 8503 See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section. 8504 8505 Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many 8506 targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate 8507 types on any target. 8508 8509 .. _i_landingpad: 8510 8511 '``landingpad``' Instruction 8512 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8513 8514 Syntax: 8515 """"""" 8516 8517 :: 8518 8519 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+ 8520 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>* 8521 8522 <clause> := catch <type> <value> 8523 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant> 8524 8525 Overview: 8526 """"""""" 8527 8528 The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling 8529 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block 8530 is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the 8531 code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It 8532 defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon 8533 re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``. 8534 8535 Arguments: 8536 """""""""" 8537 8538 The optional 8539 ``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup. 8540 8541 A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and 8542 contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught 8543 or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter`` 8544 clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use 8545 "``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The 8546 '``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or 8547 the ``cleanup`` flag. 8548 8549 Semantics: 8550 """""""""" 8551 8552 The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the 8553 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and 8554 therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with 8555 calling conventions, how the personality function results are 8556 represented in LLVM IR is target specific. 8557 8558 The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two 8559 ``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the 8560 clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses. 8561 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, 8562 the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't 8563 match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then 8564 unwinding continues further up the call stack. 8565 8566 The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions: 8567 8568 - A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination 8569 of an '``invoke``' instruction. 8570 - A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its 8571 first non-PHI instruction. 8572 - There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing 8573 pad block. 8574 - A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a 8575 '``landingpad``' instruction. 8576 8577 Example: 8578 """""""" 8579 8580 .. code-block:: llvm 8581 8582 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer. 8583 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 } 8584 catch i8** @_ZTIi 8585 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup. 8586 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 } 8587 cleanup 8588 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double. 8589 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 } 8590 catch i8** @_ZTIi 8591 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId] 8592 8593 .. _i_cleanuppad: 8594 8595 '``cleanuppad``' Instruction 8596 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8597 8598 Syntax: 8599 """"""" 8600 8601 :: 8602 8603 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*] 8604 8605 Overview: 8606 """"""""" 8607 8608 The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling 8609 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block 8610 is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to 8611 transfer control to run cleanup actions. 8612 The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional 8613 information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to 8614 execute the cleanup. 8615 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to 8616 match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`. 8617 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the 8618 ``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet, 8619 this operand may be the token ``none``. 8620 8621 Arguments: 8622 """""""""" 8623 8624 The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted 8625 by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`. 8626 8627 Semantics: 8628 """""""""" 8629 8630 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, 8631 the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the 8632 ``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments. 8633 As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are 8634 represented in LLVM IR is target specific. 8635 8636 The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions: 8637 8638 - A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of 8639 an exceptional instruction. 8640 - A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its 8641 first non-PHI instruction. 8642 - There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the 8643 cleanup block. 8644 - A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a 8645 '``cleanuppad``' instruction. 8646 8647 Executing a ``cleanuppad`` instruction constitutes "entering" that pad. 8648 The pad may then be "exited" in one of three ways: 8649 8650 1) explicitly via a ``cleanupret`` that consumes it. Executing such a ``cleanupret`` 8651 is undefined behavior if any descendant pads have been entered but not yet 8652 exited. 8653 2) implicitly via a call (which unwinds all the way to the current function's caller), 8654 or via a ``catchswitch`` or a ``cleanupret`` that unwinds to caller. 8655 3) implicitly via an unwind edge whose destination EH pad isn't a descendant of 8656 the ``cleanuppad``. When the ``cleanuppad`` is exited in this manner, it is 8657 undefined behavior if the destination EH pad has a parent which is not an 8658 ancestor of the ``cleanuppad`` being exited. 8659 8660 It is undefined behavior for the ``cleanuppad`` to exit via an unwind edge which 8661 does not transitively unwind to the same destination as a constituent 8662 ``cleanupret``. 8663 8664 Example: 8665 """""""" 8666 8667 .. code-block:: llvm 8668 8669 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs [] 8670 8671 .. _intrinsics: 8672 8673 Intrinsic Functions 8674 =================== 8675 8676 LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions 8677 have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain 8678 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism 8679 for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the 8680 transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode 8681 reader/writer, the parser, etc...). 8682 8683 Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This 8684 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may 8685 not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external 8686 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic 8687 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal 8688 to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because 8689 intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any 8690 are added that they be documented here. 8691 8692 Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic 8693 represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on 8694 different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million 8695 different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an 8696 intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the 8697 argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any 8698 integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a 8699 previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic 8700 function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be 8701 of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single 8702 argument or the result. 8703 8704 Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument 8705 types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only 8706 those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments 8707 whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the 8708 ``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an 8709 integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of 8710 functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and 8711 ``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is 8712 overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's 8713 type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own 8714 name suffix. 8715 8716 To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending 8717 LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_. 8718 8719 .. _int_varargs: 8720 8721 Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics 8722 ------------------------------------- 8723 8724 Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the 8725 :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic 8726 functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros 8727 defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file. 8728 8729 All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific 8730 value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual 8731 does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be 8732 prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used. 8733 8734 This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the 8735 variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used. 8736 8737 .. code-block:: llvm 8738 8739 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms, 8740 ; it is merely an i8*. 8741 %struct.va_list = type { i8* } 8742 8743 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct: 8744 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* } 8745 8746 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) { 8747 ; Initialize variable argument processing 8748 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list 8749 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8* 8750 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2) 8751 8752 ; Read a single integer argument 8753 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32 8754 8755 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end 8756 %aq = alloca i8* 8757 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8* 8758 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2) 8759 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2) 8760 8761 ; Stop processing of arguments. 8762 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2) 8763 ret i32 %tmp 8764 } 8765 8766 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*) 8767 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*) 8768 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*) 8769 8770 .. _int_va_start: 8771 8772 '``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic 8773 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8774 8775 Syntax: 8776 """"""" 8777 8778 :: 8779 8780 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>) 8781 8782 Overview: 8783 """"""""" 8784 8785 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for 8786 subsequent use by ``va_arg``. 8787 8788 Arguments: 8789 """""""""" 8790 8791 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize. 8792 8793 Semantics: 8794 """""""""" 8795 8796 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro 8797 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the 8798 ``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call 8799 to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the 8800 function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need 8801 to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure 8802 that out. 8803 8804 '``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic 8805 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8806 8807 Syntax: 8808 """"""" 8809 8810 :: 8811 8812 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>) 8813 8814 Overview: 8815 """"""""" 8816 8817 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been 8818 initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``. 8819 8820 Arguments: 8821 """""""""" 8822 8823 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy. 8824 8825 Semantics: 8826 """""""""" 8827 8828 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro 8829 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list`` 8830 element to which the argument points. Calls to 8831 :ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and 8832 :ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to 8833 ``llvm.va_end``. 8834 8835 .. _int_va_copy: 8836 8837 '``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic 8838 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8839 8840 Syntax: 8841 """"""" 8842 8843 :: 8844 8845 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>) 8846 8847 Overview: 8848 """"""""" 8849 8850 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position 8851 from the source argument list to the destination argument list. 8852 8853 Arguments: 8854 """""""""" 8855 8856 The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize. 8857 The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from. 8858 8859 Semantics: 8860 """""""""" 8861 8862 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro 8863 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source 8864 ``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This 8865 intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be 8866 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation. 8867 8868 Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics 8869 -------------------------------------- 8870 8871 LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_ 8872 (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic 8873 calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these 8874 intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector. 8875 8876 These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the 8877 stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that 8878 require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. 8879 Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate 8880 these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more 8881 details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_. 8882 8883 Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics 8884 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8885 8886 LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage 8887 collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative 8888 to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for 8889 :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The 8890 differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM 8891 <GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are 8892 described in :doc:`Statepoints`. 8893 8894 .. _int_gcroot: 8895 8896 '``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic 8897 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8898 8899 Syntax: 8900 """"""" 8901 8902 :: 8903 8904 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata) 8905 8906 Overview: 8907 """"""""" 8908 8909 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to 8910 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it. 8911 8912 Arguments: 8913 """""""""" 8914 8915 The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains 8916 the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or 8917 a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the 8918 root. 8919 8920 Semantics: 8921 """""""""" 8922 8923 At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the 8924 "ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates 8925 information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points. 8926 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which 8927 :ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`. 8928 8929 .. _int_gcread: 8930 8931 '``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic 8932 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8933 8934 Syntax: 8935 """"""" 8936 8937 :: 8938 8939 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr) 8940 8941 Overview: 8942 """"""""" 8943 8944 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap 8945 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read 8946 barriers. 8947 8948 Arguments: 8949 """""""""" 8950 8951 The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an 8952 address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a 8953 pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language 8954 runtime (otherwise null). 8955 8956 Semantics: 8957 """""""""" 8958 8959 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load 8960 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by 8961 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``' 8962 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC 8963 algorithm <gc>`. 8964 8965 .. _int_gcwrite: 8966 8967 '``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic 8968 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 8969 8970 Syntax: 8971 """"""" 8972 8973 :: 8974 8975 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2) 8976 8977 Overview: 8978 """"""""" 8979 8980 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap 8981 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write 8982 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors). 8983 8984 Arguments: 8985 """""""""" 8986 8987 The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of 8988 the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of 8989 Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the 8990 object, Obj may be null. 8991 8992 Semantics: 8993 """""""""" 8994 8995 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store 8996 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by 8997 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``' 8998 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC 8999 algorithm <gc>`. 9000 9001 Code Generator Intrinsics 9002 ------------------------- 9003 9004 These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that 9005 may only be implemented with code generator support. 9006 9007 '``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic 9008 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9009 9010 Syntax: 9011 """"""" 9012 9013 :: 9014 9015 declare i8 *@llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>) 9016 9017 Overview: 9018 """"""""" 9019 9020 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a 9021 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current 9022 function or one of its callers. 9023 9024 Arguments: 9025 """""""""" 9026 9027 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the 9028 address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its 9029 caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer 9030 value. 9031 9032 Semantics: 9033 """""""""" 9034 9035 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer 9036 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it 9037 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to 9038 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be 9039 used for debugging purposes. 9040 9041 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or 9042 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that 9043 of the obvious source-language caller. 9044 9045 '``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic 9046 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9047 9048 Syntax: 9049 """"""" 9050 9051 :: 9052 9053 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>) 9054 9055 Overview: 9056 """"""""" 9057 9058 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the 9059 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame. 9060 9061 Arguments: 9062 """""""""" 9063 9064 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the 9065 frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates 9066 its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer 9067 value. 9068 9069 Semantics: 9070 """""""""" 9071 9072 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer 9073 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it 9074 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to 9075 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be 9076 used for debugging purposes. 9077 9078 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or 9079 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that 9080 of the obvious source-language caller. 9081 9082 '``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics 9083 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9084 9085 Syntax: 9086 """"""" 9087 9088 :: 9089 9090 declare void @llvm.localescape(...) 9091 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx) 9092 9093 Overview: 9094 """"""""" 9095 9096 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static 9097 allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a 9098 live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is 9099 computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``. 9100 9101 Arguments: 9102 """""""""" 9103 9104 All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or 9105 casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``' 9106 once, and it can only do so from the entry block. 9107 9108 The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant 9109 bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code 9110 generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in 9111 other modules. 9112 9113 The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a 9114 call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``' 9115 is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable 9116 pointer in platform-specific ways. 9117 9118 The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to 9119 '``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed. 9120 9121 Semantics: 9122 """""""""" 9123 9124 These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local 9125 stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the 9126 '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the 9127 child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas. 9128 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where 9129 the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use 9130 '``llvm.localrecover``'. 9131 9132 .. _int_read_register: 9133 .. _int_write_register: 9134 9135 '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics 9136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9137 9138 Syntax: 9139 """"""" 9140 9141 :: 9142 9143 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata) 9144 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata) 9145 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value) 9146 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value) 9147 !0 = !{!"sp\00"} 9148 9149 Overview: 9150 """"""""" 9151 9152 The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics 9153 provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on 9154 the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible 9155 with the register being read. 9156 9157 Semantics: 9158 """""""""" 9159 9160 The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the 9161 register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets 9162 the current value of the register, where possible. 9163 9164 This is useful to implement named register global variables that need 9165 to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on 9166 bare-metal programs including OS kernels. 9167 9168 The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used 9169 register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that, 9170 allocatable registers are not supported. 9171 9172 Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected 9173 architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of 9174 work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable 9175 registers. 9176 9177 .. _int_stacksave: 9178 9179 '``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic 9180 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9181 9182 Syntax: 9183 """"""" 9184 9185 :: 9186 9187 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave() 9188 9189 Overview: 9190 """"""""" 9191 9192 The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state 9193 of the function stack, for use with 9194 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for 9195 implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized 9196 arrays in C99. 9197 9198 Semantics: 9199 """""""""" 9200 9201 This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to 9202 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an 9203 ``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from 9204 ``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to 9205 the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In 9206 practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that 9207 were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed. 9208 9209 .. _int_stackrestore: 9210 9211 '``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic 9212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9213 9214 Syntax: 9215 """"""" 9216 9217 :: 9218 9219 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr) 9220 9221 Overview: 9222 """"""""" 9223 9224 The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of 9225 the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding 9226 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is 9227 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable 9228 sized arrays in C99. 9229 9230 Semantics: 9231 """""""""" 9232 9233 See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`. 9234 9235 .. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset: 9236 9237 '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic 9238 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9239 9240 Syntax: 9241 """"""" 9242 9243 :: 9244 9245 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32() 9246 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64() 9247 9248 Overview: 9249 """"""""" 9250 9251 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to 9252 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most 9253 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are 9254 intendend for use in combination with 9255 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a 9256 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example, 9257 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines. 9258 9259 Semantics: 9260 """""""""" 9261 9262 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to 9263 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` 9264 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards, 9265 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most 9266 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more 9267 complicated, because substracting this value from stack pointer would get the address 9268 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca. 9269 9270 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>` 9271 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a 9272 compile-time-known constant value. 9273 9274 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>` 9275 must match the target's generic address space's (address space 0) pointer type. 9276 9277 '``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic 9278 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9279 9280 Syntax: 9281 """"""" 9282 9283 :: 9284 9285 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>) 9286 9287 Overview: 9288 """"""""" 9289 9290 The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to 9291 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop. 9292 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change 9293 its performance characteristics. 9294 9295 Arguments: 9296 """""""""" 9297 9298 ``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier 9299 determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and 9300 ``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no 9301 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type`` 9302 specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or 9303 instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type`` 9304 arguments must be constant integers. 9305 9306 Semantics: 9307 """""""""" 9308 9309 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In 9310 particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On 9311 targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to 9312 the processor cache for better performance. 9313 9314 '``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic 9315 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9316 9317 Syntax: 9318 """"""" 9319 9320 :: 9321 9322 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>) 9323 9324 Overview: 9325 """"""""" 9326 9327 The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program 9328 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The 9329 method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use 9330 exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no 9331 guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after 9332 optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit 9333 optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to 9334 allow correlations of simulation runs. 9335 9336 Arguments: 9337 """""""""" 9338 9339 ``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker. 9340 9341 Semantics: 9342 """""""""" 9343 9344 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends 9345 that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it. 9346 9347 '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic 9348 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9349 9350 Syntax: 9351 """"""" 9352 9353 :: 9354 9355 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter() 9356 9357 Overview: 9358 """"""""" 9359 9360 The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle 9361 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those 9362 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it 9363 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the 9364 order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small 9365 timings. 9366 9367 Semantics: 9368 """""""""" 9369 9370 When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any 9371 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application 9372 specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this 9373 is lowered to a constant 0. 9374 9375 Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is 9376 running at and the host platform. 9377 9378 '``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic 9379 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9380 9381 Syntax: 9382 """"""" 9383 9384 :: 9385 9386 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*) 9387 9388 Overview: 9389 """"""""" 9390 9391 The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications 9392 in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On 9393 targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation 9394 flushes the instruction cache. 9395 9396 Semantics: 9397 """""""""" 9398 9399 On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this 9400 intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data 9401 cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate 9402 instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special 9403 privileges. 9404 9405 The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run 9406 time library. 9407 9408 This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications 9409 of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic. 9410 9411 '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' Intrinsic 9412 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9413 9414 Syntax: 9415 """"""" 9416 9417 :: 9418 9419 declare void @llvm.instrprof_increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>, 9420 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>) 9421 9422 Overview: 9423 """"""""" 9424 9425 The '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a 9426 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be 9427 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a 9428 program at runtime. 9429 9430 Arguments: 9431 """""""""" 9432 9433 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the 9434 name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the 9435 (mangled) function name for a set of counters. 9436 9437 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer 9438 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and 9439 the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an 9440 error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of 9441 ``instrprof_increment`` that refer to the same name. 9442 9443 The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should 9444 be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``. 9445 9446 Semantics: 9447 """""""""" 9448 9449 This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will 9450 cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data 9451 structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a 9452 format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via 9453 the ``llvm-profdata`` tool. 9454 9455 '``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' Intrinsic 9456 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9457 9458 Syntax: 9459 """"""" 9460 9461 :: 9462 9463 declare void @llvm.instrprof_value_profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>, 9464 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>, 9465 i32 <index>) 9466 9467 Overview: 9468 """"""""" 9469 9470 The '``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a 9471 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be 9472 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values, 9473 instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime. 9474 9475 Arguments: 9476 """""""""" 9477 9478 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the 9479 name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the 9480 (mangled) function name for a set of counters. 9481 9482 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer 9483 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It 9484 is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of 9485 ``llvm.instrprof_*`` that refer to the same name. 9486 9487 The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled 9488 expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The 9489 fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The 9490 supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the 9491 ``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the 9492 ``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the 9493 index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0. 9494 9495 Semantics: 9496 """""""""" 9497 9498 This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine 9499 should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof`` 9500 pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the 9501 ``llvm.instrprof_value_profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile 9502 runtime library with proper arguments. 9503 9504 Standard C Library Intrinsics 9505 ----------------------------- 9506 9507 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library 9508 functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass 9509 information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code 9510 generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation. 9511 9512 .. _int_memcpy: 9513 9514 '``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic 9515 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9516 9517 Syntax: 9518 """"""" 9519 9520 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any 9521 integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets 9522 support all bit widths however. 9523 9524 :: 9525 9526 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>, 9527 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>) 9528 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>, 9529 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>) 9530 9531 Overview: 9532 """"""""" 9533 9534 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the 9535 source location to the destination location. 9536 9537 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*`` 9538 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile 9539 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces. 9540 9541 Arguments: 9542 """""""""" 9543 9544 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a 9545 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument 9546 specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the 9547 alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a 9548 boolean indicating a volatile access. 9549 9550 If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1, 9551 then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers 9552 are aligned to that boundary. 9553 9554 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is 9555 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not 9556 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it. 9557 9558 Semantics: 9559 """""""""" 9560 9561 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the 9562 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to 9563 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known 9564 to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth 9565 argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment). 9566 9567 '``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic 9568 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9569 9570 Syntax: 9571 """"""" 9572 9573 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer 9574 bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all 9575 bit widths however. 9576 9577 :: 9578 9579 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>, 9580 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>) 9581 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>, 9582 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>) 9583 9584 Overview: 9585 """"""""" 9586 9587 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the 9588 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the 9589 '``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to 9590 overlap. 9591 9592 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*`` 9593 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile 9594 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces. 9595 9596 Arguments: 9597 """""""""" 9598 9599 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a 9600 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument 9601 specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the 9602 alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a 9603 boolean indicating a volatile access. 9604 9605 If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1, 9606 then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are 9607 aligned to that boundary. 9608 9609 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call 9610 is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is 9611 not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it. 9612 9613 Semantics: 9614 """""""""" 9615 9616 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the 9617 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It 9618 copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be 9619 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, 9620 otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment). 9621 9622 '``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics 9623 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9624 9625 Syntax: 9626 """"""" 9627 9628 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer 9629 bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets 9630 support all bit widths. 9631 9632 :: 9633 9634 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>, 9635 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>) 9636 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>, 9637 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>) 9638 9639 Overview: 9640 """"""""" 9641 9642 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a 9643 particular byte value. 9644 9645 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset`` 9646 intrinsic does not return a value and takes extra alignment/volatile 9647 arguments. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space. 9648 9649 Arguments: 9650 """""""""" 9651 9652 The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second 9653 is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an 9654 integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth 9655 argument is the known alignment of the destination location. 9656 9657 If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1, 9658 then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to 9659 that boundary. 9660 9661 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is 9662 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not 9663 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it. 9664 9665 Semantics: 9666 """""""""" 9667 9668 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting 9669 at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to 9670 some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise 9671 it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment). 9672 9673 '``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic 9674 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9675 9676 Syntax: 9677 """"""" 9678 9679 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any 9680 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9681 all types however. 9682 9683 :: 9684 9685 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val) 9686 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val) 9687 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9688 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val) 9689 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9690 9691 Overview: 9692 """"""""" 9693 9694 The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand, 9695 returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``' functions would. Unlike 9696 ``sqrt`` in libm, however, ``llvm.sqrt`` has undefined behavior for 9697 negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better optimization, 9698 because there is no need to worry about errno being set). 9699 ``llvm.sqrt(-0.0)`` is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt. 9700 9701 Arguments: 9702 """""""""" 9703 9704 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9705 type. 9706 9707 Semantics: 9708 """""""""" 9709 9710 This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a 9711 nonnegative floating point number. 9712 9713 '``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic 9714 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9715 9716 Syntax: 9717 """"""" 9718 9719 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any 9720 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9721 all types however. 9722 9723 :: 9724 9725 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power) 9726 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power) 9727 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power) 9728 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power) 9729 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power) 9730 9731 Overview: 9732 """"""""" 9733 9734 The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the 9735 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of 9736 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is 9737 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value. 9738 9739 Arguments: 9740 """""""""" 9741 9742 The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to 9743 raise to that power. 9744 9745 Semantics: 9746 """""""""" 9747 9748 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an 9749 unspecified sequence of rounding operations. 9750 9751 '``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic 9752 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9753 9754 Syntax: 9755 """"""" 9756 9757 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any 9758 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9759 all types however. 9760 9761 :: 9762 9763 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val) 9764 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val) 9765 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9766 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val) 9767 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9768 9769 Overview: 9770 """"""""" 9771 9772 The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand. 9773 9774 Arguments: 9775 """""""""" 9776 9777 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9778 type. 9779 9780 Semantics: 9781 """""""""" 9782 9783 This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the 9784 same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error 9785 conditions in the same way. 9786 9787 '``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic 9788 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9789 9790 Syntax: 9791 """"""" 9792 9793 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any 9794 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9795 all types however. 9796 9797 :: 9798 9799 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val) 9800 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val) 9801 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9802 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val) 9803 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9804 9805 Overview: 9806 """"""""" 9807 9808 The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand. 9809 9810 Arguments: 9811 """""""""" 9812 9813 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9814 type. 9815 9816 Semantics: 9817 """""""""" 9818 9819 This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the 9820 same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error 9821 conditions in the same way. 9822 9823 '``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic 9824 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9825 9826 Syntax: 9827 """"""" 9828 9829 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any 9830 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9831 all types however. 9832 9833 :: 9834 9835 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power) 9836 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power) 9837 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power) 9838 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power) 9839 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power) 9840 9841 Overview: 9842 """"""""" 9843 9844 The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the 9845 specified (positive or negative) power. 9846 9847 Arguments: 9848 """""""""" 9849 9850 The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value 9851 to raise to that power. 9852 9853 Semantics: 9854 """""""""" 9855 9856 This function returns the first value raised to the second power, 9857 returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and 9858 handles error conditions in the same way. 9859 9860 '``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic 9861 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9862 9863 Syntax: 9864 """"""" 9865 9866 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any 9867 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9868 all types however. 9869 9870 :: 9871 9872 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val) 9873 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val) 9874 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9875 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val) 9876 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9877 9878 Overview: 9879 """"""""" 9880 9881 The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics perform the exp function. 9882 9883 Arguments: 9884 """""""""" 9885 9886 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9887 type. 9888 9889 Semantics: 9890 """""""""" 9891 9892 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions 9893 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 9894 9895 '``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic 9896 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9897 9898 Syntax: 9899 """"""" 9900 9901 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any 9902 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9903 all types however. 9904 9905 :: 9906 9907 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val) 9908 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val) 9909 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9910 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val) 9911 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9912 9913 Overview: 9914 """"""""" 9915 9916 The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics perform the exp2 function. 9917 9918 Arguments: 9919 """""""""" 9920 9921 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9922 type. 9923 9924 Semantics: 9925 """""""""" 9926 9927 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions 9928 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 9929 9930 '``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic 9931 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9932 9933 Syntax: 9934 """"""" 9935 9936 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any 9937 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9938 all types however. 9939 9940 :: 9941 9942 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val) 9943 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val) 9944 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9945 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val) 9946 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9947 9948 Overview: 9949 """"""""" 9950 9951 The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics perform the log function. 9952 9953 Arguments: 9954 """""""""" 9955 9956 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9957 type. 9958 9959 Semantics: 9960 """""""""" 9961 9962 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions 9963 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 9964 9965 '``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic 9966 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 9967 9968 Syntax: 9969 """"""" 9970 9971 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any 9972 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 9973 all types however. 9974 9975 :: 9976 9977 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val) 9978 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val) 9979 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 9980 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val) 9981 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 9982 9983 Overview: 9984 """"""""" 9985 9986 The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics perform the log10 function. 9987 9988 Arguments: 9989 """""""""" 9990 9991 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 9992 type. 9993 9994 Semantics: 9995 """""""""" 9996 9997 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions 9998 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 9999 10000 '``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic 10001 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10002 10003 Syntax: 10004 """"""" 10005 10006 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any 10007 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10008 all types however. 10009 10010 :: 10011 10012 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val) 10013 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val) 10014 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10015 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val) 10016 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10017 10018 Overview: 10019 """"""""" 10020 10021 The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics perform the log2 function. 10022 10023 Arguments: 10024 """""""""" 10025 10026 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10027 type. 10028 10029 Semantics: 10030 """""""""" 10031 10032 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions 10033 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10034 10035 '``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic 10036 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10037 10038 Syntax: 10039 """"""" 10040 10041 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any 10042 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10043 all types however. 10044 10045 :: 10046 10047 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) 10048 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c) 10049 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c) 10050 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c) 10051 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c) 10052 10053 Overview: 10054 """"""""" 10055 10056 The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add 10057 operation. 10058 10059 Arguments: 10060 """""""""" 10061 10062 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10063 type. 10064 10065 Semantics: 10066 """""""""" 10067 10068 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fma`` functions 10069 would, and does not set errno. 10070 10071 '``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic 10072 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10073 10074 Syntax: 10075 """"""" 10076 10077 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any 10078 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10079 all types however. 10080 10081 :: 10082 10083 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val) 10084 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val) 10085 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10086 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val) 10087 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10088 10089 Overview: 10090 """"""""" 10091 10092 The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the 10093 operand. 10094 10095 Arguments: 10096 """""""""" 10097 10098 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10099 type. 10100 10101 Semantics: 10102 """""""""" 10103 10104 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions 10105 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10106 10107 '``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic 10108 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10109 10110 Syntax: 10111 """"""" 10112 10113 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any 10114 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10115 all types however. 10116 10117 :: 10118 10119 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1) 10120 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1) 10121 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1) 10122 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1) 10123 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1) 10124 10125 Overview: 10126 """"""""" 10127 10128 The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two 10129 arguments. 10130 10131 10132 Arguments: 10133 """""""""" 10134 10135 The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10136 type. 10137 10138 Semantics: 10139 """""""""" 10140 10141 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm's 10142 fmin. 10143 10144 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns 10145 NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal, 10146 returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that 10147 fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0. 10148 10149 '``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic 10150 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10151 10152 Syntax: 10153 """"""" 10154 10155 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any 10156 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10157 all types however. 10158 10159 :: 10160 10161 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l) 10162 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1) 10163 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1) 10164 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1) 10165 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1) 10166 10167 Overview: 10168 """"""""" 10169 10170 The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two 10171 arguments. 10172 10173 10174 Arguments: 10175 """""""""" 10176 10177 The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10178 type. 10179 10180 Semantics: 10181 """""""""" 10182 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm's 10183 fmax. 10184 10185 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns 10186 NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal, 10187 returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that 10188 fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0. 10189 10190 '``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic 10191 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10192 10193 Syntax: 10194 """"""" 10195 10196 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any 10197 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10198 all types however. 10199 10200 :: 10201 10202 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn) 10203 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn) 10204 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn) 10205 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn) 10206 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn) 10207 10208 Overview: 10209 """"""""" 10210 10211 The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the 10212 first operand and the sign of the second operand. 10213 10214 Arguments: 10215 """""""""" 10216 10217 The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10218 type. 10219 10220 Semantics: 10221 """""""""" 10222 10223 This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign`` 10224 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10225 10226 '``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic 10227 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10228 10229 Syntax: 10230 """"""" 10231 10232 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any 10233 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10234 all types however. 10235 10236 :: 10237 10238 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val) 10239 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val) 10240 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10241 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val) 10242 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10243 10244 Overview: 10245 """"""""" 10246 10247 The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand. 10248 10249 Arguments: 10250 """""""""" 10251 10252 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10253 type. 10254 10255 Semantics: 10256 """""""""" 10257 10258 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions 10259 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10260 10261 '``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic 10262 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10263 10264 Syntax: 10265 """"""" 10266 10267 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any 10268 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10269 all types however. 10270 10271 :: 10272 10273 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val) 10274 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val) 10275 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10276 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val) 10277 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10278 10279 Overview: 10280 """"""""" 10281 10282 The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand. 10283 10284 Arguments: 10285 """""""""" 10286 10287 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10288 type. 10289 10290 Semantics: 10291 """""""""" 10292 10293 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions 10294 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10295 10296 '``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic 10297 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10298 10299 Syntax: 10300 """"""" 10301 10302 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any 10303 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10304 all types however. 10305 10306 :: 10307 10308 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val) 10309 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val) 10310 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10311 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val) 10312 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10313 10314 Overview: 10315 """"""""" 10316 10317 The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the 10318 nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand. 10319 10320 Arguments: 10321 """""""""" 10322 10323 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10324 type. 10325 10326 Semantics: 10327 """""""""" 10328 10329 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions 10330 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10331 10332 '``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic 10333 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10334 10335 Syntax: 10336 """"""" 10337 10338 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any 10339 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10340 all types however. 10341 10342 :: 10343 10344 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val) 10345 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val) 10346 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10347 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val) 10348 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10349 10350 Overview: 10351 """"""""" 10352 10353 The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the 10354 nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the 10355 operand isn't an integer. 10356 10357 Arguments: 10358 """""""""" 10359 10360 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10361 type. 10362 10363 Semantics: 10364 """""""""" 10365 10366 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions 10367 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10368 10369 '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic 10370 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10371 10372 Syntax: 10373 """"""" 10374 10375 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any 10376 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10377 all types however. 10378 10379 :: 10380 10381 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val) 10382 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val) 10383 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10384 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val) 10385 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10386 10387 Overview: 10388 """"""""" 10389 10390 The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the 10391 nearest integer. 10392 10393 Arguments: 10394 """""""""" 10395 10396 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10397 type. 10398 10399 Semantics: 10400 """""""""" 10401 10402 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint`` 10403 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10404 10405 '``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic 10406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10407 10408 Syntax: 10409 """"""" 10410 10411 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any 10412 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support 10413 all types however. 10414 10415 :: 10416 10417 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val) 10418 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val) 10419 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val) 10420 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val) 10421 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val) 10422 10423 Overview: 10424 """"""""" 10425 10426 The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the 10427 nearest integer. 10428 10429 Arguments: 10430 """""""""" 10431 10432 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same 10433 type. 10434 10435 Semantics: 10436 """""""""" 10437 10438 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round`` 10439 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way. 10440 10441 Bit Manipulation Intrinsics 10442 --------------------------- 10443 10444 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation 10445 operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms. 10446 10447 '``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics 10448 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10449 10450 Syntax: 10451 """"""" 10452 10453 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any 10454 integer type. 10455 10456 :: 10457 10458 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>) 10459 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>) 10460 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>) 10461 10462 Overview: 10463 """"""""" 10464 10465 The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the 10466 bitpattern of an integer value; for example ``0b1234567`` becomes 10467 ``0b7654321``. 10468 10469 Semantics: 10470 """""""""" 10471 10472 The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has bit 10473 ``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output. 10474 10475 '``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics 10476 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10477 10478 Syntax: 10479 """"""" 10480 10481 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any 10482 integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0). 10483 10484 :: 10485 10486 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>) 10487 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>) 10488 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>) 10489 10490 Overview: 10491 """"""""" 10492 10493 The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer 10494 values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits). 10495 These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the 10496 target's native byte order. 10497 10498 Semantics: 10499 """""""""" 10500 10501 The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high 10502 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32`` 10503 intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32 10504 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the 10505 returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The 10506 ``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this 10507 concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more, 10508 respectively). 10509 10510 '``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic 10511 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10512 10513 Syntax: 10514 """"""" 10515 10516 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer 10517 bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets 10518 support all bit widths or vector types, however. 10519 10520 :: 10521 10522 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>) 10523 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>) 10524 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>) 10525 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>) 10526 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>) 10527 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>) 10528 10529 Overview: 10530 """"""""" 10531 10532 The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set 10533 in a value. 10534 10535 Arguments: 10536 """""""""" 10537 10538 The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any 10539 integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must 10540 match the argument type. 10541 10542 Semantics: 10543 """""""""" 10544 10545 The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within 10546 each element of a vector. 10547 10548 '``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic 10549 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10550 10551 Syntax: 10552 """"""" 10553 10554 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any 10555 integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all 10556 targets support all bit widths or vector types, however. 10557 10558 :: 10559 10560 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10561 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10562 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10563 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10564 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10565 declase <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10566 10567 Overview: 10568 """"""""" 10569 10570 The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of 10571 leading zeros in a variable. 10572 10573 Arguments: 10574 """""""""" 10575 10576 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of 10577 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return 10578 type must match the first argument type. 10579 10580 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether 10581 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a 10582 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a 10583 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are 10584 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs. 10585 10586 Semantics: 10587 """""""""" 10588 10589 The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant) 10590 zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If 10591 ``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` 10592 if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example, 10593 ``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``. 10594 10595 '``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic 10596 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10597 10598 Syntax: 10599 """"""" 10600 10601 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any 10602 integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets 10603 support all bit widths or vector types, however. 10604 10605 :: 10606 10607 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10608 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10609 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10610 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10611 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10612 declase <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>) 10613 10614 Overview: 10615 """"""""" 10616 10617 The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of 10618 trailing zeros. 10619 10620 Arguments: 10621 """""""""" 10622 10623 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of 10624 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return 10625 type must match the first argument type. 10626 10627 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether 10628 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a 10629 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a 10630 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are 10631 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs. 10632 10633 Semantics: 10634 """""""""" 10635 10636 The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant) 10637 zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0`` 10638 then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if 10639 ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example, 10640 ``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``. 10641 10642 .. _int_overflow: 10643 10644 Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics 10645 ----------------------------------- 10646 10647 LLVM provides intrinsics for some arithmetic with overflow operations. 10648 10649 '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics 10650 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10651 10652 Syntax: 10653 """"""" 10654 10655 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow`` 10656 on any integer bit width. 10657 10658 :: 10659 10660 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b) 10661 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10662 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b) 10663 10664 Overview: 10665 """"""""" 10666 10667 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10668 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow 10669 occurred during the signed summation. 10670 10671 Arguments: 10672 """""""""" 10673 10674 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure 10675 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same 10676 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type 10677 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed 10678 addition. 10679 10680 Semantics: 10681 """""""""" 10682 10683 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10684 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the 10685 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element 10686 of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an 10687 overflow. 10688 10689 Examples: 10690 """"""""" 10691 10692 .. code-block:: llvm 10693 10694 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10695 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0 10696 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1 10697 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal 10698 10699 '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics 10700 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10701 10702 Syntax: 10703 """"""" 10704 10705 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow`` 10706 on any integer bit width. 10707 10708 :: 10709 10710 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b) 10711 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10712 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b) 10713 10714 Overview: 10715 """"""""" 10716 10717 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10718 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry 10719 occurred during the unsigned summation. 10720 10721 Arguments: 10722 """""""""" 10723 10724 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure 10725 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same 10726 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type 10727 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned 10728 addition. 10729 10730 Semantics: 10731 """""""""" 10732 10733 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10734 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the 10735 first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a 10736 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry. 10737 10738 Examples: 10739 """"""""" 10740 10741 .. code-block:: llvm 10742 10743 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10744 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0 10745 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1 10746 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal 10747 10748 '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics 10749 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10750 10751 Syntax: 10752 """"""" 10753 10754 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow`` 10755 on any integer bit width. 10756 10757 :: 10758 10759 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b) 10760 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10761 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b) 10762 10763 Overview: 10764 """"""""" 10765 10766 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10767 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an 10768 overflow occurred during the signed subtraction. 10769 10770 Arguments: 10771 """""""""" 10772 10773 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure 10774 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same 10775 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type 10776 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed 10777 subtraction. 10778 10779 Semantics: 10780 """""""""" 10781 10782 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10783 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the 10784 first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of 10785 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an 10786 overflow. 10787 10788 Examples: 10789 """"""""" 10790 10791 .. code-block:: llvm 10792 10793 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10794 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0 10795 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1 10796 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal 10797 10798 '``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics 10799 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10800 10801 Syntax: 10802 """"""" 10803 10804 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow`` 10805 on any integer bit width. 10806 10807 :: 10808 10809 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b) 10810 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10811 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b) 10812 10813 Overview: 10814 """"""""" 10815 10816 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10817 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an 10818 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction. 10819 10820 Arguments: 10821 """""""""" 10822 10823 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure 10824 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same 10825 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type 10826 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned 10827 subtraction. 10828 10829 Semantics: 10830 """""""""" 10831 10832 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10833 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- 10834 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of 10835 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an 10836 overflow. 10837 10838 Examples: 10839 """"""""" 10840 10841 .. code-block:: llvm 10842 10843 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10844 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0 10845 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1 10846 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal 10847 10848 '``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics 10849 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10850 10851 Syntax: 10852 """"""" 10853 10854 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow`` 10855 on any integer bit width. 10856 10857 :: 10858 10859 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b) 10860 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10861 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b) 10862 10863 Overview: 10864 """"""""" 10865 10866 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10867 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an 10868 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication. 10869 10870 Arguments: 10871 """""""""" 10872 10873 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure 10874 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same 10875 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type 10876 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed 10877 multiplication. 10878 10879 Semantics: 10880 """""""""" 10881 10882 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10883 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure --- 10884 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element 10885 of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an 10886 overflow. 10887 10888 Examples: 10889 """"""""" 10890 10891 .. code-block:: llvm 10892 10893 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10894 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0 10895 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1 10896 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal 10897 10898 '``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics 10899 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10900 10901 Syntax: 10902 """"""" 10903 10904 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow`` 10905 on any integer bit width. 10906 10907 :: 10908 10909 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b) 10910 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10911 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b) 10912 10913 Overview: 10914 """"""""" 10915 10916 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10917 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an 10918 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication. 10919 10920 Arguments: 10921 """""""""" 10922 10923 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure 10924 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same 10925 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type 10926 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned 10927 multiplication. 10928 10929 Semantics: 10930 """""""""" 10931 10932 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform 10933 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure --- 10934 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second 10935 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication 10936 resulted in an overflow. 10937 10938 Examples: 10939 """"""""" 10940 10941 .. code-block:: llvm 10942 10943 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b) 10944 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0 10945 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1 10946 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal 10947 10948 Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics 10949 --------------------------------- 10950 10951 '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic 10952 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 10953 10954 Syntax: 10955 """"""" 10956 10957 :: 10958 10959 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a) 10960 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b) 10961 10962 Overview: 10963 """"""""" 10964 10965 The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical 10966 encoding of a floating point number. This canonicalization is useful for 10967 implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is 10968 defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be: 10969 10970 :: 10971 10972 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point 10973 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite 10974 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats. 10975 10976 This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008 10977 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled 10978 according to section 6.2. 10979 10980 Examples of non-canonical encodings: 10981 10982 - x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are 10983 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol. 10984 - Many normal decimal floating point numbers have non-canonical alternative 10985 encodings. 10986 - Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values. 10987 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and with be flushed to 10988 a zero of the same sign by this operation. 10989 10990 Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with 10991 default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a 10992 quiet NaN result. 10993 10994 This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided 10995 that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by 10996 1.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with 10997 -0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity. 10998 10999 ``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is: 11000 11001 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)`` 11002 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to 11003 to ``(x == y)`` 11004 11005 Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved: 11006 ``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0`` 11007 11008 The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions. 11009 First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN 11010 must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the 11011 usual methods. 11012 11013 The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if: 11014 11015 - The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a 11016 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical. 11017 - The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point 11018 operations. That is, the bits of the floating point value are not examined. 11019 11020 '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic 11021 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11022 11023 Syntax: 11024 """"""" 11025 11026 :: 11027 11028 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) 11029 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c) 11030 11031 Overview: 11032 """"""""" 11033 11034 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add 11035 expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the 11036 target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the 11037 fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul 11038 and add instructions. 11039 11040 Arguments: 11041 """""""""" 11042 11043 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two 11044 multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c. 11045 11046 Semantics: 11047 """""""""" 11048 11049 The expression: 11050 11051 :: 11052 11053 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c) 11054 11055 is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will 11056 not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the 11057 code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if 11058 the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the 11059 corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used 11060 instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'. 11061 11062 Examples: 11063 """"""""" 11064 11065 .. code-block:: llvm 11066 11067 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c 11068 11069 Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics 11070 ---------------------------------------- 11071 11072 For most target platforms, half precision floating point is a 11073 storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory) 11074 but does not support computation in the format. 11075 11076 This means that code must first load the half-precision floating point 11077 value as an i16, then convert it to float with 11078 :ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can 11079 then be performed on the float value (including extending to double 11080 etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float 11081 if needed, then converted to i16 with 11082 :ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an 11083 i16 value. 11084 11085 .. _int_convert_to_fp16: 11086 11087 '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic 11088 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11089 11090 Syntax: 11091 """"""" 11092 11093 :: 11094 11095 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a) 11096 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a) 11097 11098 Overview: 11099 """"""""" 11100 11101 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a 11102 conventional floating point type to half precision floating point format. 11103 11104 Arguments: 11105 """""""""" 11106 11107 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be 11108 converted. 11109 11110 Semantics: 11111 """""""""" 11112 11113 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a 11114 conventional floating point format to half precision floating point format. The 11115 return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number. 11116 11117 Examples: 11118 """"""""" 11119 11120 .. code-block:: llvm 11121 11122 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a) 11123 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2 11124 11125 .. _int_convert_from_fp16: 11126 11127 '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic 11128 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11129 11130 Syntax: 11131 """"""" 11132 11133 :: 11134 11135 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a) 11136 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a) 11137 11138 Overview: 11139 """"""""" 11140 11141 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a 11142 conversion from half precision floating point format to single precision 11143 floating point format. 11144 11145 Arguments: 11146 """""""""" 11147 11148 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be 11149 converted. 11150 11151 Semantics: 11152 """""""""" 11153 11154 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a 11155 conversion from half single precision floating point format to single 11156 precision floating point format. The input half-float value is 11157 represented by an ``i16`` value. 11158 11159 Examples: 11160 """"""""" 11161 11162 .. code-block:: llvm 11163 11164 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2 11165 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a) 11166 11167 .. _dbg_intrinsics: 11168 11169 Debugger Intrinsics 11170 ------------------- 11171 11172 The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.`` 11173 prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level 11174 Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_ 11175 document. 11176 11177 Exception Handling Intrinsics 11178 ----------------------------- 11179 11180 The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with 11181 ``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception 11182 Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_ document. 11183 11184 .. _int_trampoline: 11185 11186 Trampoline Intrinsics 11187 --------------------- 11188 11189 These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with 11190 the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a 11191 callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does 11192 not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored 11193 in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the 11194 stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the 11195 argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address 11196 extension. 11197 11198 For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)`` 11199 then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``. 11200 It can be created as follows: 11201 11202 .. code-block:: llvm 11203 11204 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86 11205 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0 11206 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval) 11207 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1) 11208 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)* 11209 11210 The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to 11211 ``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``. 11212 11213 .. _int_it: 11214 11215 '``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic 11216 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11217 11218 Syntax: 11219 """"""" 11220 11221 :: 11222 11223 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>) 11224 11225 Overview: 11226 """"""""" 11227 11228 This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code, 11229 turning it into a trampoline. 11230 11231 Arguments: 11232 """""""""" 11233 11234 The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all 11235 pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and 11236 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the 11237 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific - 11238 LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a 11239 front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some 11240 target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function 11241 bitcast to an ``i8*``. 11242 11243 Semantics: 11244 """""""""" 11245 11246 The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target 11247 dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be 11248 passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can 11249 be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new 11250 function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments 11251 marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest`` 11252 argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new 11253 function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list, 11254 but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after 11255 calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is 11256 modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function 11257 pointer is undefined. 11258 11259 .. _int_at: 11260 11261 '``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic 11262 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11263 11264 Syntax: 11265 """"""" 11266 11267 :: 11268 11269 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>) 11270 11271 Overview: 11272 """"""""" 11273 11274 This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of 11275 a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``). 11276 11277 Arguments: 11278 """""""""" 11279 11280 ``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline 11281 code filled in by a previous call to 11282 :ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`. 11283 11284 Semantics: 11285 """""""""" 11286 11287 On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be 11288 different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This 11289 intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp`` 11290 after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer 11291 returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`. 11292 11293 .. _int_mload_mstore: 11294 11295 Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics 11296 --------------------------------------- 11297 11298 LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed. 11299 11300 .. _int_mload: 11301 11302 '``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics 11303 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11304 11305 Syntax: 11306 """"""" 11307 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. 11308 11309 :: 11310 11311 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>) 11312 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>) 11313 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double 11314 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>) 11315 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers 11316 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>) 11317 11318 Overview: 11319 """"""""" 11320 11321 Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand. 11322 11323 11324 Arguments: 11325 """""""""" 11326 11327 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types. 11328 11329 11330 Semantics: 11331 """""""""" 11332 11333 The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations. 11334 The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes. 11335 11336 11337 :: 11338 11339 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru) 11340 11341 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception 11342 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4 11343 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru 11344 11345 .. _int_mstore: 11346 11347 '``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics 11348 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11349 11350 Syntax: 11351 """"""" 11352 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. 11353 11354 :: 11355 11356 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>) 11357 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>) 11358 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double 11359 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>) 11360 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers 11361 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>) 11362 11363 Overview: 11364 """"""""" 11365 11366 Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. 11367 11368 Arguments: 11369 """""""""" 11370 11371 The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements. 11372 11373 11374 Semantics: 11375 """""""""" 11376 11377 The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations. 11378 The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes. 11379 11380 :: 11381 11382 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask) 11383 11384 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions 11385 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4 11386 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval 11387 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4 11388 11389 11390 Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics 11391 ------------------------------------------- 11392 11393 LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed. 11394 11395 .. _int_mgather: 11396 11397 '``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics 11398 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11399 11400 Syntax: 11401 """"""" 11402 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector. 11403 11404 :: 11405 11406 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>) 11407 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64 (<2 x double*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>) 11408 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>) 11409 11410 Overview: 11411 """"""""" 11412 11413 Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand. 11414 11415 11416 Arguments: 11417 """""""""" 11418 11419 The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types. 11420 11421 11422 Semantics: 11423 """""""""" 11424 11425 The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations. 11426 The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks. 11427 11428 11429 :: 11430 11431 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1>%mask, <4 x double> <true, true, true, true>) 11432 11433 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence 11434 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0 11435 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1 11436 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2 11437 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3 11438 11439 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8 11440 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8 11441 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8 11442 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8 11443 11444 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0 11445 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1 11446 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2 11447 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3 11448 11449 .. _int_mscatter: 11450 11451 '``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics 11452 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11453 11454 Syntax: 11455 """"""" 11456 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element. 11457 11458 :: 11459 11460 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>) 11461 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>) 11462 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>) 11463 11464 Overview: 11465 """"""""" 11466 11467 Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. 11468 11469 Arguments: 11470 """""""""" 11471 11472 The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements. 11473 11474 11475 Semantics: 11476 """""""""" 11477 11478 The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations. 11479 11480 :: 11481 11482 ;; This instruction unconditionaly stores data vector in multiple addresses 11483 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>) 11484 11485 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores 11486 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0 11487 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1 11488 .. 11489 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7 11490 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0 11491 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1 11492 .. 11493 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7 11494 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap: 11495 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4 11496 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4 11497 .. 11498 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4 11499 11500 11501 Memory Use Markers 11502 ------------------ 11503 11504 This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of 11505 memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable. 11506 11507 .. _int_lifestart: 11508 11509 '``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic 11510 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11511 11512 Syntax: 11513 """"""" 11514 11515 :: 11516 11517 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>) 11518 11519 Overview: 11520 """"""""" 11521 11522 The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory 11523 object's lifetime. 11524 11525 Arguments: 11526 """""""""" 11527 11528 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the 11529 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer 11530 to the object. 11531 11532 Semantics: 11533 """""""""" 11534 11535 This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value 11536 of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known 11537 to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer 11538 that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``. 11539 11540 .. _int_lifeend: 11541 11542 '``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic 11543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11544 11545 Syntax: 11546 """"""" 11547 11548 :: 11549 11550 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>) 11551 11552 Overview: 11553 """"""""" 11554 11555 The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory 11556 object's lifetime. 11557 11558 Arguments: 11559 """""""""" 11560 11561 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the 11562 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer 11563 to the object. 11564 11565 Semantics: 11566 """""""""" 11567 11568 This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of 11569 the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to 11570 never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory 11571 object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead. 11572 11573 '``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic 11574 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11575 11576 Syntax: 11577 """"""" 11578 11579 :: 11580 11581 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>) 11582 11583 Overview: 11584 """"""""" 11585 11586 The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of 11587 a memory object will not change. 11588 11589 Arguments: 11590 """""""""" 11591 11592 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the 11593 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer 11594 to the object. 11595 11596 Semantics: 11597 """""""""" 11598 11599 This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses 11600 the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and 11601 unchanging. 11602 11603 '``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic 11604 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11605 11606 Syntax: 11607 """"""" 11608 11609 :: 11610 11611 declare void @llvm.invariant.end({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>) 11612 11613 Overview: 11614 """"""""" 11615 11616 The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a 11617 memory object are mutable. 11618 11619 Arguments: 11620 """""""""" 11621 11622 The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic. 11623 The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the 11624 object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a 11625 pointer to the object. 11626 11627 Semantics: 11628 """""""""" 11629 11630 This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again. 11631 11632 '``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' Intrinsic 11633 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11634 11635 Syntax: 11636 """"""" 11637 11638 :: 11639 11640 declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* <ptr>) 11641 11642 Overview: 11643 """"""""" 11644 11645 The '``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant 11646 established by invariant.group metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer 11647 value that does not carry the invariant information. 11648 11649 11650 Arguments: 11651 """""""""" 11652 11653 The ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` takes only one argument, which is 11654 the pointer to the memory for which the ``invariant.group`` no longer holds. 11655 11656 Semantics: 11657 """""""""" 11658 11659 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different 11660 for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata. 11661 11662 General Intrinsics 11663 ------------------ 11664 11665 This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific 11666 purpose. 11667 11668 '``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic 11669 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11670 11671 Syntax: 11672 """"""" 11673 11674 :: 11675 11676 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11677 11678 Overview: 11679 """"""""" 11680 11681 The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic. 11682 11683 Arguments: 11684 """""""""" 11685 11686 The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a 11687 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the 11688 source file name, and the last argument is the line number. 11689 11690 Semantics: 11691 """""""""" 11692 11693 This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary 11694 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want 11695 to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are 11696 ignored by code generation and optimization. 11697 11698 '``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic 11699 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11700 11701 Syntax: 11702 """"""" 11703 11704 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a 11705 pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for 11706 the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer 11707 '``0``'. 11708 11709 :: 11710 11711 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11712 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11713 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11714 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11715 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11716 11717 Overview: 11718 """"""""" 11719 11720 The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic. 11721 11722 Arguments: 11723 """""""""" 11724 11725 The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth 11726 (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the 11727 third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the 11728 last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument. 11729 11730 Semantics: 11731 """""""""" 11732 11733 This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary 11734 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look 11735 for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code 11736 generation and optimization. 11737 11738 '``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic 11739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11740 11741 Syntax: 11742 """"""" 11743 11744 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on 11745 any integer bit width. 11746 11747 :: 11748 11749 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11750 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11751 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11752 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11753 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>) 11754 11755 Overview: 11756 """"""""" 11757 11758 The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic. 11759 11760 Arguments: 11761 """""""""" 11762 11763 The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the 11764 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a 11765 global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is 11766 the line number. It returns the value of the first argument. 11767 11768 Semantics: 11769 """""""""" 11770 11771 This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions 11772 with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose 11773 optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no 11774 other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization. 11775 11776 '``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic 11777 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11778 11779 Syntax: 11780 """"""" 11781 11782 :: 11783 11784 declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind 11785 11786 Overview: 11787 """"""""" 11788 11789 The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic. 11790 11791 Arguments: 11792 """""""""" 11793 11794 None. 11795 11796 Semantics: 11797 """""""""" 11798 11799 This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If 11800 the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be 11801 lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function. 11802 11803 '``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic 11804 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11805 11806 Syntax: 11807 """"""" 11808 11809 :: 11810 11811 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind 11812 11813 Overview: 11814 """"""""" 11815 11816 The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic. 11817 11818 Arguments: 11819 """""""""" 11820 11821 None. 11822 11823 Semantics: 11824 """""""""" 11825 11826 This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an 11827 execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a 11828 debugger. 11829 11830 '``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic 11831 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11832 11833 Syntax: 11834 """"""" 11835 11836 :: 11837 11838 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>) 11839 11840 Overview: 11841 """"""""" 11842 11843 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it 11844 onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it 11845 is placed on the stack before local variables. 11846 11847 Arguments: 11848 """""""""" 11849 11850 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments. 11851 The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard 11852 ``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has 11853 enough space to hold the value of the guard. 11854 11855 Semantics: 11856 """""""""" 11857 11858 This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of 11859 the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is 11860 to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy 11861 the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is 11862 checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are 11863 different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by 11864 calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function. 11865 11866 '``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``' Intrinsic 11867 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11868 11869 Syntax: 11870 """"""" 11871 11872 :: 11873 11874 declare void @llvm.stackprotectorcheck(i8** <guard>) 11875 11876 Overview: 11877 """"""""" 11878 11879 The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic compares ``guard`` against an already 11880 created stack protector and if they are not equal calls the 11881 ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function. 11882 11883 Arguments: 11884 """""""""" 11885 11886 The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic requires one pointer argument, the 11887 the variable ``@__stack_chk_guard``. 11888 11889 Semantics: 11890 """""""""" 11891 11892 This intrinsic is provided to perform the stack protector check by comparing 11893 ``guard`` with the stack slot created by ``llvm.stackprotector`` and if the 11894 values do not match call the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function. 11895 11896 The reason to provide this as an IR level intrinsic instead of implementing it 11897 via other IR operations is that in order to perform this operation at the IR 11898 level without an intrinsic, one would need to create additional basic blocks to 11899 handle the success/failure cases. This makes it difficult to stop the stack 11900 protector check from disrupting sibling tail calls in Codegen. With this 11901 intrinsic, we are able to generate the stack protector basic blocks late in 11902 codegen after the tail call decision has occurred. 11903 11904 '``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic 11905 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11906 11907 Syntax: 11908 """"""" 11909 11910 :: 11911 11912 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>) 11913 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>) 11914 11915 Overview: 11916 """"""""" 11917 11918 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to 11919 the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation 11920 (like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or 11921 b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this 11922 context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or 11923 other object. 11924 11925 Arguments: 11926 """""""""" 11927 11928 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first 11929 argument is a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument is 11930 a boolean and determines whether ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true) 11931 or -1 (if false) when the object size is unknown. The second argument 11932 only accepts constants. 11933 11934 Semantics: 11935 """""""""" 11936 11937 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing 11938 the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at 11939 compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending 11940 on the ``min`` argument). 11941 11942 '``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic 11943 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11944 11945 Syntax: 11946 """"""" 11947 11948 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any 11949 integer bit width. 11950 11951 :: 11952 11953 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>) 11954 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>) 11955 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>) 11956 11957 Overview: 11958 """"""""" 11959 11960 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the 11961 most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers. 11962 11963 Arguments: 11964 """""""""" 11965 11966 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is 11967 a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a 11968 constant value, variables are not allowed. 11969 11970 Semantics: 11971 """""""""" 11972 11973 This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``. 11974 11975 .. _int_assume: 11976 11977 '``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic 11978 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 11979 11980 Syntax: 11981 """"""" 11982 11983 :: 11984 11985 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond) 11986 11987 Overview: 11988 """"""""" 11989 11990 The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided 11991 condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts 11992 of the code. 11993 11994 Arguments: 11995 """""""""" 11996 11997 The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true. 11998 11999 Semantics: 12000 """""""""" 12001 12002 The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is 12003 always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is 12004 generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the 12005 provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is 12006 violated during execution, the behavior is undefined. 12007 12008 Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values 12009 used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions 12010 only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable 12011 if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause 12012 sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason, 12013 ``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants 12014 that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the 12015 optimizer. 12016 12017 .. _bitset.test: 12018 12019 '``llvm.bitset.test``' Intrinsic 12020 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 12021 12022 Syntax: 12023 """"""" 12024 12025 :: 12026 12027 declare i1 @llvm.bitset.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %bitset) nounwind readnone 12028 12029 12030 Arguments: 12031 """""""""" 12032 12033 The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a 12034 metadata object representing an identifier for a :doc:`bitset <BitSets>`. 12035 12036 Overview: 12037 """"""""" 12038 12039 The ``llvm.bitset.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is a 12040 member of the given bitset. 12041 12042 '``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic 12043 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ 12044 12045 Syntax: 12046 """"""" 12047 12048 :: 12049 12050 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone 12051 12052 Overview: 12053 """"""""" 12054 12055 The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only 12056 two intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint``) that can be called 12057 with an invoke instruction. 12058 12059 Arguments: 12060 """""""""" 12061 12062 None. 12063 12064 Semantics: 12065 """""""""" 12066 12067 This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored 12068 by codegen. 12069 12070 Stack Map Intrinsics 12071 -------------------- 12072 12073 LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching 12074 mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics 12075 are described in :doc:`StackMaps`. 12076